|  | //===- CIndex.cpp - Clang-C Source Indexing Library -----------------------===// | 
|  | // | 
|  | //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure | 
|  | // | 
|  | // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source | 
|  | // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. | 
|  | // | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // | 
|  | // This file implements the main API hooks in the Clang-C Source Indexing | 
|  | // library. | 
|  | // | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | #include "CIndexDiagnostic.h" | 
|  | #include "CIndexer.h" | 
|  | #include "CLog.h" | 
|  | #include "CXCursor.h" | 
|  | #include "CXSourceLocation.h" | 
|  | #include "CXString.h" | 
|  | #include "CXTranslationUnit.h" | 
|  | #include "CXType.h" | 
|  | #include "CursorVisitor.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/AST/Attr.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/AST/StmtVisitor.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticCategories.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticIDs.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Basic/Stack.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Basic/Version.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Frontend/ASTUnit.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Frontend/CompilerInstance.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Frontend/FrontendDiagnostic.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Index/CodegenNameGenerator.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Index/CommentToXML.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Lex/PreprocessingRecord.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" | 
|  | #include "clang/Serialization/SerializationDiagnostic.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/ADT/StringSwitch.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Config/llvm-config.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/CrashRecoveryContext.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/Format.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/ManagedStatic.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/MemoryBuffer.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/Mutex.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/Program.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/SaveAndRestore.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/Signals.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/TargetSelect.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/Threading.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/Timer.h" | 
|  | #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h" | 
|  |  | 
|  | #if LLVM_ENABLE_THREADS != 0 && defined(__APPLE__) | 
|  | #define USE_DARWIN_THREADS | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef USE_DARWIN_THREADS | 
|  | #include <pthread.h> | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | using namespace clang; | 
|  | using namespace clang::cxcursor; | 
|  | using namespace clang::cxtu; | 
|  | using namespace clang::cxindex; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit cxtu::MakeCXTranslationUnit(CIndexer *CIdx, | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<ASTUnit> AU) { | 
|  | if (!AU) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | assert(CIdx); | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit D = new CXTranslationUnitImpl(); | 
|  | D->CIdx = CIdx; | 
|  | D->TheASTUnit = AU.release(); | 
|  | D->StringPool = new cxstring::CXStringPool(); | 
|  | D->Diagnostics = nullptr; | 
|  | D->OverridenCursorsPool = createOverridenCXCursorsPool(); | 
|  | D->CommentToXML = nullptr; | 
|  | D->ParsingOptions = 0; | 
|  | D->Arguments = {}; | 
|  | return D; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool cxtu::isASTReadError(ASTUnit *AU) { | 
|  | for (ASTUnit::stored_diag_iterator D = AU->stored_diag_begin(), | 
|  | DEnd = AU->stored_diag_end(); | 
|  | D != DEnd; ++D) { | 
|  | if (D->getLevel() >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error && | 
|  | DiagnosticIDs::getCategoryNumberForDiag(D->getID()) == | 
|  | diag::DiagCat_AST_Deserialization_Issue) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | cxtu::CXTUOwner::~CXTUOwner() { | 
|  | if (TU) | 
|  | clang_disposeTranslationUnit(TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Compare two source ranges to determine their relative position in | 
|  | /// the translation unit. | 
|  | static RangeComparisonResult RangeCompare(SourceManager &SM, | 
|  | SourceRange R1, | 
|  | SourceRange R2) { | 
|  | assert(R1.isValid() && "First range is invalid?"); | 
|  | assert(R2.isValid() && "Second range is invalid?"); | 
|  | if (R1.getEnd() != R2.getBegin() && | 
|  | SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(R1.getEnd(), R2.getBegin())) | 
|  | return RangeBefore; | 
|  | if (R2.getEnd() != R1.getBegin() && | 
|  | SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(R2.getEnd(), R1.getBegin())) | 
|  | return RangeAfter; | 
|  | return RangeOverlap; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Determine if a source location falls within, before, or after a | 
|  | ///   a given source range. | 
|  | static RangeComparisonResult LocationCompare(SourceManager &SM, | 
|  | SourceLocation L, SourceRange R) { | 
|  | assert(R.isValid() && "First range is invalid?"); | 
|  | assert(L.isValid() && "Second range is invalid?"); | 
|  | if (L == R.getBegin() || L == R.getEnd()) | 
|  | return RangeOverlap; | 
|  | if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(L, R.getBegin())) | 
|  | return RangeBefore; | 
|  | if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(R.getEnd(), L)) | 
|  | return RangeAfter; | 
|  | return RangeOverlap; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Translate a Clang source range into a CIndex source range. | 
|  | /// | 
|  | /// Clang internally represents ranges where the end location points to the | 
|  | /// start of the token at the end. However, for external clients it is more | 
|  | /// useful to have a CXSourceRange be a proper half-open interval. This routine | 
|  | /// does the appropriate translation. | 
|  | CXSourceRange cxloc::translateSourceRange(const SourceManager &SM, | 
|  | const LangOptions &LangOpts, | 
|  | const CharSourceRange &R) { | 
|  | // We want the last character in this location, so we will adjust the | 
|  | // location accordingly. | 
|  | SourceLocation EndLoc = R.getEnd(); | 
|  | bool IsTokenRange = R.isTokenRange(); | 
|  | if (EndLoc.isValid() && EndLoc.isMacroID() && !SM.isMacroArgExpansion(EndLoc)) { | 
|  | CharSourceRange Expansion = SM.getExpansionRange(EndLoc); | 
|  | EndLoc = Expansion.getEnd(); | 
|  | IsTokenRange = Expansion.isTokenRange(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (IsTokenRange && EndLoc.isValid()) { | 
|  | unsigned Length = Lexer::MeasureTokenLength(SM.getSpellingLoc(EndLoc), | 
|  | SM, LangOpts); | 
|  | EndLoc = EndLoc.getLocWithOffset(Length); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceRange Result = { | 
|  | { &SM, &LangOpts }, | 
|  | R.getBegin().getRawEncoding(), | 
|  | EndLoc.getRawEncoding() | 
|  | }; | 
|  | return Result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Cursor visitor. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | static SourceRange getRawCursorExtent(CXCursor C); | 
|  | static SourceRange getFullCursorExtent(CXCursor C, SourceManager &SrcMgr); | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | RangeComparisonResult CursorVisitor::CompareRegionOfInterest(SourceRange R) { | 
|  | return RangeCompare(AU->getSourceManager(), R, RegionOfInterest); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Visit the given cursor and, if requested by the visitor, | 
|  | /// its children. | 
|  | /// | 
|  | /// \param Cursor the cursor to visit. | 
|  | /// | 
|  | /// \param CheckedRegionOfInterest if true, then the caller already checked | 
|  | /// that this cursor is within the region of interest. | 
|  | /// | 
|  | /// \returns true if the visitation should be aborted, false if it | 
|  | /// should continue. | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::Visit(CXCursor Cursor, bool CheckedRegionOfInterest) { | 
|  | if (clang_isInvalid(Cursor.kind)) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(Cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(Cursor); | 
|  | if (!D) { | 
|  | assert(0 && "Invalid declaration cursor"); | 
|  | return true; // abort. | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Ignore implicit declarations, unless it's an objc method because | 
|  | // currently we should report implicit methods for properties when indexing. | 
|  | if (D->isImplicit() && !isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If we have a range of interest, and this cursor doesn't intersect with it, | 
|  | // we're done. | 
|  | if (RegionOfInterest.isValid() && !CheckedRegionOfInterest) { | 
|  | SourceRange Range = getRawCursorExtent(Cursor); | 
|  | if (Range.isInvalid() || CompareRegionOfInterest(Range)) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (Visitor(Cursor, Parent, ClientData)) { | 
|  | case CXChildVisit_Break: | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXChildVisit_Continue: | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXChildVisit_Recurse: { | 
|  | bool ret = VisitChildren(Cursor); | 
|  | if (PostChildrenVisitor) | 
|  | if (PostChildrenVisitor(Cursor, ClientData)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | return ret; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXChildVisitResult!"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(SourceRange R, | 
|  | PreprocessingRecord &PPRec, | 
|  | CursorVisitor &Visitor) { | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = Visitor.getASTUnit()->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | FileID FID; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!Visitor.shouldVisitIncludedEntities()) { | 
|  | // If the begin/end of the range lie in the same FileID, do the optimization | 
|  | // where we skip preprocessed entities that do not come from the same FileID. | 
|  | FID = SM.getFileID(SM.getFileLoc(R.getBegin())); | 
|  | if (FID != SM.getFileID(SM.getFileLoc(R.getEnd()))) | 
|  | FID = FileID(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const auto &Entities = PPRec.getPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(R); | 
|  | return Visitor.visitPreprocessedEntities(Entities.begin(), Entities.end(), | 
|  | PPRec, FID); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::visitFileRegion() { | 
|  | if (RegionOfInterest.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = Unit->getSourceManager(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::pair<FileID, unsigned> | 
|  | Begin = SM.getDecomposedLoc(SM.getFileLoc(RegionOfInterest.getBegin())), | 
|  | End = SM.getDecomposedLoc(SM.getFileLoc(RegionOfInterest.getEnd())); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (End.first != Begin.first) { | 
|  | // If the end does not reside in the same file, try to recover by | 
|  | // picking the end of the file of begin location. | 
|  | End.first = Begin.first; | 
|  | End.second = SM.getFileIDSize(Begin.first); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | assert(Begin.first == End.first); | 
|  | if (Begin.second > End.second) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | FileID File = Begin.first; | 
|  | unsigned Offset = Begin.second; | 
|  | unsigned Length = End.second - Begin.second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!VisitDeclsOnly && !VisitPreprocessorLast) | 
|  | if (visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion()) | 
|  | return true; // visitation break. | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (visitDeclsFromFileRegion(File, Offset, Length)) | 
|  | return true; // visitation break. | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!VisitDeclsOnly && VisitPreprocessorLast) | 
|  | return visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool isInLexicalContext(Decl *D, DeclContext *DC) { | 
|  | if (!DC) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (DeclContext *DeclDC = D->getLexicalDeclContext(); | 
|  | DeclDC; DeclDC = DeclDC->getLexicalParent()) { | 
|  | if (DeclDC == DC) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::visitDeclsFromFileRegion(FileID File, | 
|  | unsigned Offset, unsigned Length) { | 
|  | ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = Unit->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | SourceRange Range = RegionOfInterest; | 
|  |  | 
|  | SmallVector<Decl *, 16> Decls; | 
|  | Unit->findFileRegionDecls(File, Offset, Length, Decls); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If we didn't find any file level decls for the file, try looking at the | 
|  | // file that it was included from. | 
|  | while (Decls.empty() || Decls.front()->isTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer()) { | 
|  | bool Invalid = false; | 
|  | const SrcMgr::SLocEntry &SLEntry = SM.getSLocEntry(File, &Invalid); | 
|  | if (Invalid) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation Outer; | 
|  | if (SLEntry.isFile()) | 
|  | Outer = SLEntry.getFile().getIncludeLoc(); | 
|  | else | 
|  | Outer = SLEntry.getExpansion().getExpansionLocStart(); | 
|  | if (Outer.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::tie(File, Offset) = SM.getDecomposedExpansionLoc(Outer); | 
|  | Length = 0; | 
|  | Unit->findFileRegionDecls(File, Offset, Length, Decls); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | assert(!Decls.empty()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool VisitedAtLeastOnce = false; | 
|  | DeclContext *CurDC = nullptr; | 
|  | SmallVectorImpl<Decl *>::iterator DIt = Decls.begin(); | 
|  | for (SmallVectorImpl<Decl *>::iterator DE = Decls.end(); DIt != DE; ++DIt) { | 
|  | Decl *D = *DIt; | 
|  | if (D->getSourceRange().isInvalid()) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isInLexicalContext(D, CurDC)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CurDC = dyn_cast<DeclContext>(D); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) | 
|  | if (!TD->isFreeStanding()) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | RangeComparisonResult CompRes = RangeCompare(SM, D->getSourceRange(),Range); | 
|  | if (CompRes == RangeBefore) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | if (CompRes == RangeAfter) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | assert(CompRes == RangeOverlap); | 
|  | VisitedAtLeastOnce = true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | FileDI_current = &DIt; | 
|  | FileDE_current = DE; | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | FileDI_current = nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D, TU, Range), /*CheckedRegionOfInterest=*/true)) | 
|  | return true; // visitation break. | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (VisitedAtLeastOnce) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // No Decls overlapped with the range. Move up the lexical context until there | 
|  | // is a context that contains the range or we reach the translation unit | 
|  | // level. | 
|  | DeclContext *DC = DIt == Decls.begin() ? (*DIt)->getLexicalDeclContext() | 
|  | : (*(DIt-1))->getLexicalDeclContext(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (DC && !DC->isTranslationUnit()) { | 
|  | Decl *D = cast<Decl>(DC); | 
|  | SourceRange CurDeclRange = D->getSourceRange(); | 
|  | if (CurDeclRange.isInvalid()) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (RangeCompare(SM, CurDeclRange, Range) == RangeOverlap) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D, TU, Range), /*CheckedRegionOfInterest=*/true)) | 
|  | return true; // visitation break. | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | DC = D->getLexicalDeclContext(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion() { | 
|  | if (!AU->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | PreprocessingRecord &PPRec | 
|  | = *AU->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord(); | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = AU->getSourceManager(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (RegionOfInterest.isValid()) { | 
|  | SourceRange MappedRange = AU->mapRangeToPreamble(RegionOfInterest); | 
|  | SourceLocation B = MappedRange.getBegin(); | 
|  | SourceLocation E = MappedRange.getEnd(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (AU->isInPreambleFileID(B)) { | 
|  | if (SM.isLoadedSourceLocation(E)) | 
|  | return visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(SourceRange(B, E), | 
|  | PPRec, *this); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Beginning of range lies in the preamble but it also extends beyond | 
|  | // it into the main file. Split the range into 2 parts, one covering | 
|  | // the preamble and another covering the main file. This allows subsequent | 
|  | // calls to visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange to accept a source range that | 
|  | // lies in the same FileID, allowing it to skip preprocessed entities that | 
|  | // do not come from the same FileID. | 
|  | bool breaked = | 
|  | visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange( | 
|  | SourceRange(B, AU->getEndOfPreambleFileID()), | 
|  | PPRec, *this); | 
|  | if (breaked) return true; | 
|  | return visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange( | 
|  | SourceRange(AU->getStartOfMainFileID(), E), | 
|  | PPRec, *this); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRange(SourceRange(B, E), PPRec, *this); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool OnlyLocalDecls | 
|  | = !AU->isMainFileAST() && AU->getOnlyLocalDecls(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (OnlyLocalDecls) | 
|  | return visitPreprocessedEntities(PPRec.local_begin(), PPRec.local_end(), | 
|  | PPRec); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return visitPreprocessedEntities(PPRec.begin(), PPRec.end(), PPRec); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | template<typename InputIterator> | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::visitPreprocessedEntities(InputIterator First, | 
|  | InputIterator Last, | 
|  | PreprocessingRecord &PPRec, | 
|  | FileID FID) { | 
|  | for (; First != Last; ++First) { | 
|  | if (!FID.isInvalid() && !PPRec.isEntityInFileID(First, FID)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | PreprocessedEntity *PPE = *First; | 
|  | if (!PPE) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (MacroExpansion *ME = dyn_cast<MacroExpansion>(PPE)) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeMacroExpansionCursor(ME, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (MacroDefinitionRecord *MD = dyn_cast<MacroDefinitionRecord>(PPE)) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeMacroDefinitionCursor(MD, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (InclusionDirective *ID = dyn_cast<InclusionDirective>(PPE)) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeInclusionDirectiveCursor(ID, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Visit the children of the given cursor. | 
|  | /// | 
|  | /// \returns true if the visitation should be aborted, false if it | 
|  | /// should continue. | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitChildren(CXCursor Cursor) { | 
|  | if (clang_isReference(Cursor.kind) && | 
|  | Cursor.kind != CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier) { | 
|  | // By definition, references have no children. | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Set the Parent field to Cursor, then back to its old value once we're | 
|  | // done. | 
|  | SetParentRAII SetParent(Parent, StmtParent, Cursor); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(Cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | Decl *D = const_cast<Decl *>(getCursorDecl(Cursor)); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitAttributes(D) || Visit(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isStatement(Cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | if (const Stmt *S = getCursorStmt(Cursor)) | 
|  | return Visit(S); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(Cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | if (const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(Cursor)) | 
|  | return Visit(E); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isTranslationUnit(Cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU = getCursorTU(Cursor); | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | int VisitOrder[2] = { VisitPreprocessorLast, !VisitPreprocessorLast }; | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0; I != 2; ++I) { | 
|  | if (VisitOrder[I]) { | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit->isMainFileAST() && CXXUnit->getOnlyLocalDecls() && | 
|  | RegionOfInterest.isInvalid()) { | 
|  | for (ASTUnit::top_level_iterator TL = CXXUnit->top_level_begin(), | 
|  | TLEnd = CXXUnit->top_level_end(); | 
|  | TL != TLEnd; ++TL) { | 
|  | const Optional<bool> V = handleDeclForVisitation(*TL); | 
|  | if (!V.hasValue()) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | return V.getValue(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } else if (VisitDeclContext( | 
|  | CXXUnit->getASTContext().getTranslationUnitDecl())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Walk the preprocessing record. | 
|  | if (CXXUnit->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord()) | 
|  | visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier) { | 
|  | if (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Base = getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(Cursor)) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *BaseTSInfo = Base->getTypeSourceInfo()) { | 
|  | return Visit(BaseTSInfo->getTypeLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_IBOutletCollectionAttr) { | 
|  | const IBOutletCollectionAttr *A = | 
|  | cast<IBOutletCollectionAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(Cursor)); | 
|  | if (const ObjCObjectType *ObjT = A->getInterface()->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) | 
|  | return Visit(cxcursor::MakeCursorObjCClassRef( | 
|  | ObjT->getInterface(), | 
|  | A->getInterfaceLoc()->getTypeLoc().getLocStart(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If pointing inside a macro definition, check if the token is an identifier | 
|  | // that was ever defined as a macro. In such a case, create a "pseudo" macro | 
|  | // expansion cursor for that token. | 
|  | SourceLocation BeginLoc = RegionOfInterest.getBegin(); | 
|  | if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition && | 
|  | BeginLoc == RegionOfInterest.getEnd()) { | 
|  | SourceLocation Loc = AU->mapLocationToPreamble(BeginLoc); | 
|  | const MacroInfo *MI = | 
|  | getMacroInfo(cxcursor::getCursorMacroDefinition(Cursor), TU); | 
|  | if (MacroDefinitionRecord *MacroDef = | 
|  | checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(MI, Loc, TU)) | 
|  | return Visit(cxcursor::MakeMacroExpansionCursor(MacroDef, BeginLoc, TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Nothing to visit at the moment. | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitBlockDecl(BlockDecl *B) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = B->getSignatureAsWritten()) | 
|  | if (Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Stmt *Body = B->getBody()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Body, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Optional<bool> CursorVisitor::shouldVisitCursor(CXCursor Cursor) { | 
|  | if (RegionOfInterest.isValid()) { | 
|  | SourceRange Range = getFullCursorExtent(Cursor, AU->getSourceManager()); | 
|  | if (Range.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return None; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (CompareRegionOfInterest(Range)) { | 
|  | case RangeBefore: | 
|  | // This declaration comes before the region of interest; skip it. | 
|  | return None; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case RangeAfter: | 
|  | // This declaration comes after the region of interest; we're done. | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case RangeOverlap: | 
|  | // This declaration overlaps the region of interest; visit it. | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitDeclContext(DeclContext *DC) { | 
|  | DeclContext::decl_iterator I = DC->decls_begin(), E = DC->decls_end(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: Eventually remove.  This part of a hack to support proper | 
|  | // iteration over all Decls contained lexically within an ObjC container. | 
|  | SaveAndRestore<DeclContext::decl_iterator*> DI_saved(DI_current, &I); | 
|  | SaveAndRestore<DeclContext::decl_iterator> DE_saved(DE_current, E); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for ( ; I != E; ++I) { | 
|  | Decl *D = *I; | 
|  | if (D->getLexicalDeclContext() != DC) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | const Optional<bool> V = handleDeclForVisitation(D); | 
|  | if (!V.hasValue()) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | return V.getValue(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Optional<bool> CursorVisitor::handleDeclForVisitation(const Decl *D) { | 
|  | CXCursor Cursor = MakeCXCursor(D, TU, RegionOfInterest); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Ignore synthesized ivars here, otherwise if we have something like: | 
|  | //   @synthesize prop = _prop; | 
|  | // and '_prop' is not declared, we will encounter a '_prop' ivar before | 
|  | // encountering the 'prop' synthesize declaration and we will think that | 
|  | // we passed the region-of-interest. | 
|  | if (auto *ivarD = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | if (ivarD->getSynthesize()) | 
|  | return None; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: ObjCClassRef/ObjCProtocolRef for forward class/protocol | 
|  | // declarations is a mismatch with the compiler semantics. | 
|  | if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCInterfaceDecl) { | 
|  | auto *ID = cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D); | 
|  | if (!ID->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) | 
|  | Cursor = MakeCursorObjCClassRef(ID, ID->getLocation(), TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | } else if (Cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCProtocolDecl) { | 
|  | auto *PD = cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(D); | 
|  | if (!PD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) | 
|  | Cursor = MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(PD, PD->getLocation(), TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Optional<bool> V = shouldVisitCursor(Cursor); | 
|  | if (!V.hasValue()) | 
|  | return None; | 
|  | if (!V.getValue()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | if (Visit(Cursor, true)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | return None; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTranslationUnitDecl(TranslationUnitDecl *D) { | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Translation units are visited directly by Visit()"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypeAliasTemplateDecl(TypeAliasTemplateDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(D->getTemplatedDecl(), TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypeAliasDecl(TypeAliasDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = D->getTypeSourceInfo()) | 
|  | return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypedefDecl(TypedefDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = D->getTypeSourceInfo()) | 
|  | return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTagDecl(TagDecl *D) { | 
|  | return VisitDeclContext(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitClassTemplateSpecializationDecl( | 
|  | ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *D) { | 
|  | bool ShouldVisitBody = false; | 
|  | switch (D->getSpecializationKind()) { | 
|  | case TSK_Undeclared: | 
|  | case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation: | 
|  | // Nothing to visit | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration: | 
|  | case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization: | 
|  | ShouldVisitBody = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the template arguments used in the specialization. | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *SpecType = D->getTypeAsWritten()) { | 
|  | TypeLoc TL = SpecType->getTypeLoc(); | 
|  | if (TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TSTLoc = | 
|  | TL.getAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>()) { | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = TSTLoc.getNumArgs(); I != N; ++I) | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(TSTLoc.getArgLoc(I))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return ShouldVisitBody && VisitCXXRecordDecl(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl( | 
|  | ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *D) { | 
|  | // FIXME: Visit the "outer" template parameter lists on the TagDecl | 
|  | // before visiting these template parameters. | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the partial specialization arguments. | 
|  | const ASTTemplateArgumentListInfo *Info = D->getTemplateArgsAsWritten(); | 
|  | const TemplateArgumentLoc *TemplateArgs = Info->getTemplateArgs(); | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = Info->NumTemplateArgs; I != N; ++I) | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(TemplateArgs[I])) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitCXXRecordDecl(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateTypeParmDecl(TemplateTypeParmDecl *D) { | 
|  | // Visit the default argument. | 
|  | if (D->hasDefaultArgument() && !D->defaultArgumentWasInherited()) | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *DefArg = D->getDefaultArgumentInfo()) | 
|  | if (Visit(DefArg->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitEnumConstantDecl(EnumConstantDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (Expr *Init = D->getInitExpr()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Init, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *DD) { | 
|  | unsigned NumParamList = DD->getNumTemplateParameterLists(); | 
|  | for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumParamList; i++) { | 
|  | TemplateParameterList* Params = DD->getTemplateParameterList(i); | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateParameters(Params)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = DD->getTypeSourceInfo()) | 
|  | if (Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the nested-name-specifier, if present. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = DD->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool HasTrailingReturnType(FunctionDecl *ND) { | 
|  | const QualType Ty = ND->getType(); | 
|  | if (const FunctionType *AFT = Ty->getAs<FunctionType>()) { | 
|  | if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(AFT)) | 
|  | return FT->hasTrailingReturn(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Compare two base or member initializers based on their source order. | 
|  | static int CompareCXXCtorInitializers(CXXCtorInitializer *const *X, | 
|  | CXXCtorInitializer *const *Y) { | 
|  | return (*X)->getSourceOrder() - (*Y)->getSourceOrder(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *ND) { | 
|  | unsigned NumParamList = ND->getNumTemplateParameterLists(); | 
|  | for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumParamList; i++) { | 
|  | TemplateParameterList* Params = ND->getTemplateParameterList(i); | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateParameters(Params)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = ND->getTypeSourceInfo()) { | 
|  | // Visit the function declaration's syntactic components in the order | 
|  | // written. This requires a bit of work. | 
|  | TypeLoc TL = TSInfo->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens(); | 
|  | FunctionTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>(); | 
|  | const bool HasTrailingRT = HasTrailingReturnType(ND); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If we have a function declared directly (without the use of a typedef), | 
|  | // visit just the return type. Otherwise, just visit the function's type | 
|  | // now. | 
|  | if ((FTL && !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(ND) && !HasTrailingRT && | 
|  | Visit(FTL.getReturnLoc())) || | 
|  | (!FTL && Visit(TL))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the nested-name-specifier, if present. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = ND->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the declaration name. | 
|  | if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(ND)) | 
|  | if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(ND->getNameInfo())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: Visit explicitly-specified template arguments! | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the function parameters, if we have a function type. | 
|  | if (FTL && VisitFunctionTypeLoc(FTL, true)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the function's trailing return type. | 
|  | if (FTL && HasTrailingRT && Visit(FTL.getReturnLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: Attributes? | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ND->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && !ND->isLateTemplateParsed()) { | 
|  | if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ND)) { | 
|  | // Find the initializers that were written in the source. | 
|  | SmallVector<CXXCtorInitializer *, 4> WrittenInits; | 
|  | for (auto *I : Constructor->inits()) { | 
|  | if (!I->isWritten()) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | WrittenInits.push_back(I); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Sort the initializers in source order | 
|  | llvm::array_pod_sort(WrittenInits.begin(), WrittenInits.end(), | 
|  | &CompareCXXCtorInitializers); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the initializers in source order | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = WrittenInits.size(); I != N; ++I) { | 
|  | CXXCtorInitializer *Init = WrittenInits[I]; | 
|  | if (Init->isAnyMemberInitializer()) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorMemberRef(Init->getAnyMember(), | 
|  | Init->getMemberLocation(), TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } else if (TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = Init->getTypeSourceInfo()) { | 
|  | if (Visit(TInfo->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the initializer value. | 
|  | if (Expr *Initializer = Init->getInit()) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(Initializer, ND, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(ND->getBody(), StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitFieldDecl(FieldDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (VisitDeclaratorDecl(D)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Expr *BitWidth = D->getBitWidth()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(BitWidth, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Expr *Init = D->getInClassInitializer()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Init, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitVarDecl(VarDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (VisitDeclaratorDecl(D)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Expr *Init = D->getInit()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Init, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitNonTypeTemplateParmDecl(NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (VisitDeclaratorDecl(D)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (D->hasDefaultArgument() && !D->defaultArgumentWasInherited()) | 
|  | if (Expr *DefArg = D->getDefaultArgument()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(DefArg, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitFunctionTemplateDecl(FunctionTemplateDecl *D) { | 
|  | // FIXME: Visit the "outer" template parameter lists on the FunctionDecl | 
|  | // before visiting these template parameters. | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | auto* FD = D->getTemplatedDecl(); | 
|  | return VisitAttributes(FD) || VisitFunctionDecl(FD); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitClassTemplateDecl(ClassTemplateDecl *D) { | 
|  | // FIXME: Visit the "outer" template parameter lists on the TagDecl | 
|  | // before visiting these template parameters. | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | auto* CD = D->getTemplatedDecl(); | 
|  | return VisitAttributes(CD) || VisitCXXRecordDecl(CD); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateParameters(D->getTemplateParameters())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (D->hasDefaultArgument() && !D->defaultArgumentWasInherited() && | 
|  | VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(D->getDefaultArgument())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCTypeParamDecl(ObjCTypeParamDecl *D) { | 
|  | // Visit the bound, if it's explicit. | 
|  | if (D->hasExplicitBound()) { | 
|  | if (auto TInfo = D->getTypeSourceInfo()) { | 
|  | if (Visit(TInfo->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCMethodDecl(ObjCMethodDecl *ND) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = ND->getReturnTypeSourceInfo()) | 
|  | if (Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (const auto *P : ND->parameters()) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(P, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return ND->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && | 
|  | Visit(MakeCXCursor(ND->getBody(), StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | template <typename DeclIt> | 
|  | static void addRangedDeclsInContainer(DeclIt *DI_current, DeclIt DE_current, | 
|  | SourceManager &SM, SourceLocation EndLoc, | 
|  | SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &Decls) { | 
|  | DeclIt next = *DI_current; | 
|  | while (++next != DE_current) { | 
|  | Decl *D_next = *next; | 
|  | if (!D_next) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | SourceLocation L = D_next->getLocStart(); | 
|  | if (!L.isValid()) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(L, EndLoc)) { | 
|  | *DI_current = next; | 
|  | Decls.push_back(D_next); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCContainerDecl(ObjCContainerDecl *D) { | 
|  | // FIXME: Eventually convert back to just 'VisitDeclContext()'.  Essentially | 
|  | // an @implementation can lexically contain Decls that are not properly | 
|  | // nested in the AST.  When we identify such cases, we need to retrofit | 
|  | // this nesting here. | 
|  | if (!DI_current && !FileDI_current) | 
|  | return VisitDeclContext(D); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Scan the Decls that immediately come after the container | 
|  | // in the current DeclContext.  If any fall within the | 
|  | // container's lexical region, stash them into a vector | 
|  | // for later processing. | 
|  | SmallVector<Decl *, 24> DeclsInContainer; | 
|  | SourceLocation EndLoc = D->getSourceRange().getEnd(); | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = AU->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | if (EndLoc.isValid()) { | 
|  | if (DI_current) { | 
|  | addRangedDeclsInContainer(DI_current, DE_current, SM, EndLoc, | 
|  | DeclsInContainer); | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | addRangedDeclsInContainer(FileDI_current, FileDE_current, SM, EndLoc, | 
|  | DeclsInContainer); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // The common case. | 
|  | if (DeclsInContainer.empty()) | 
|  | return VisitDeclContext(D); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Get all the Decls in the DeclContext, and sort them with the | 
|  | // additional ones we've collected.  Then visit them. | 
|  | for (auto *SubDecl : D->decls()) { | 
|  | if (!SubDecl || SubDecl->getLexicalDeclContext() != D || | 
|  | SubDecl->getLocStart().isInvalid()) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | DeclsInContainer.push_back(SubDecl); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Now sort the Decls so that they appear in lexical order. | 
|  | llvm::sort(DeclsInContainer.begin(), DeclsInContainer.end(), | 
|  | [&SM](Decl *A, Decl *B) { | 
|  | SourceLocation L_A = A->getLocStart(); | 
|  | SourceLocation L_B = B->getLocStart(); | 
|  | return L_A != L_B ? | 
|  | SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(L_A, L_B) : | 
|  | SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(A->getLocEnd(), B->getLocEnd()); | 
|  | }); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Now visit the decls. | 
|  | for (SmallVectorImpl<Decl*>::iterator I = DeclsInContainer.begin(), | 
|  | E = DeclsInContainer.end(); I != E; ++I) { | 
|  | CXCursor Cursor = MakeCXCursor(*I, TU, RegionOfInterest); | 
|  | const Optional<bool> &V = shouldVisitCursor(Cursor); | 
|  | if (!V.hasValue()) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | if (!V.getValue()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | if (Visit(Cursor, true)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCCategoryDecl(ObjCCategoryDecl *ND) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCClassRef(ND->getClassInterface(), ND->getLocation(), | 
|  | TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (VisitObjCTypeParamList(ND->getTypeParamList())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ObjCCategoryDecl::protocol_loc_iterator PL = ND->protocol_loc_begin(); | 
|  | for (ObjCCategoryDecl::protocol_iterator I = ND->protocol_begin(), | 
|  | E = ND->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I, ++PL) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(*I, *PL, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitObjCContainerDecl(ND); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCProtocolDecl(ObjCProtocolDecl *PID) { | 
|  | if (!PID->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(PID, PID->getLocation(), TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_loc_iterator PL = PID->protocol_loc_begin(); | 
|  | for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PID->protocol_begin(), | 
|  | E = PID->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I, ++PL) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(*I, *PL, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitObjCContainerDecl(PID); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCPropertyDecl(ObjCPropertyDecl *PD) { | 
|  | if (PD->getTypeSourceInfo() && Visit(PD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: This implements a workaround with @property declarations also being | 
|  | // installed in the DeclContext for the @interface.  Eventually this code | 
|  | // should be removed. | 
|  | ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(PD->getDeclContext()); | 
|  | if (!CDecl || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = CDecl->getClassInterface(); | 
|  | if (!ID) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | IdentifierInfo *PropertyId = PD->getIdentifier(); | 
|  | ObjCPropertyDecl *prevDecl = | 
|  | ObjCPropertyDecl::findPropertyDecl(cast<DeclContext>(ID), PropertyId, | 
|  | PD->getQueryKind()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!prevDecl) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit synthesized methods since they will be skipped when visiting | 
|  | // the @interface. | 
|  | if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = prevDecl->getGetterMethodDecl()) | 
|  | if (MD->isPropertyAccessor() && MD->getLexicalDeclContext() == CDecl) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(MD, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = prevDecl->getSetterMethodDecl()) | 
|  | if (MD->isPropertyAccessor() && MD->getLexicalDeclContext() == CDecl) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(MD, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCTypeParamList(ObjCTypeParamList *typeParamList) { | 
|  | if (!typeParamList) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (auto *typeParam : *typeParamList) { | 
|  | // Visit the type parameter. | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(typeParam, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCInterfaceDecl(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (!D->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { | 
|  | // Forward declaration is treated like a reference. | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorObjCClassRef(D, D->getLocation(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Objective-C type parameters. | 
|  | if (VisitObjCTypeParamList(D->getTypeParamListAsWritten())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Issue callbacks for super class. | 
|  | if (D->getSuperClass() && | 
|  | Visit(MakeCursorObjCSuperClassRef(D->getSuperClass(), | 
|  | D->getSuperClassLoc(), | 
|  | TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *SuperClassTInfo = D->getSuperClassTInfo()) | 
|  | if (Visit(SuperClassTInfo->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ObjCInterfaceDecl::protocol_loc_iterator PL = D->protocol_loc_begin(); | 
|  | for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::protocol_iterator I = D->protocol_begin(), | 
|  | E = D->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I, ++PL) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(*I, *PL, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitObjCContainerDecl(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCImplDecl(ObjCImplDecl *D) { | 
|  | return VisitObjCContainerDecl(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCCategoryImplDecl(ObjCCategoryImplDecl *D) { | 
|  | // 'ID' could be null when dealing with invalid code. | 
|  | if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = D->getClassInterface()) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCClassRef(ID, D->getLocation(), TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitObjCImplDecl(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCImplementationDecl(ObjCImplementationDecl *D) { | 
|  | #if 0 | 
|  | // Issue callbacks for super class. | 
|  | // FIXME: No source location information! | 
|  | if (D->getSuperClass() && | 
|  | Visit(MakeCursorObjCSuperClassRef(D->getSuperClass(), | 
|  | D->getSuperClassLoc(), | 
|  | TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitObjCImplDecl(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCPropertyImplDecl(ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PD) { | 
|  | if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = PD->getPropertyIvarDecl()) | 
|  | if (PD->isIvarNameSpecified()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorMemberRef(Ivar, PD->getPropertyIvarDeclLoc(), TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitNamespaceDecl(NamespaceDecl *D) { | 
|  | return VisitDeclContext(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitNamespaceAliasDecl(NamespaceAliasDecl *D) { | 
|  | // Visit nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(D->getAliasedNamespace(), | 
|  | D->getTargetNameLoc(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitUsingDecl(UsingDecl *D) { | 
|  | // Visit nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc()) { | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(D, D->getLocation(), TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitDeclarationNameInfo(D->getNameInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitUsingDirectiveDecl(UsingDirectiveDecl *D) { | 
|  | // Visit nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(D->getNominatedNamespaceAsWritten(), | 
|  | D->getIdentLocation(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitUnresolvedUsingValueDecl(UnresolvedUsingValueDecl *D) { | 
|  | // Visit nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc()) { | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitDeclarationNameInfo(D->getNameInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitUnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl( | 
|  | UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *D) { | 
|  | // Visit nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitStaticAssertDecl(StaticAssertDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D->getAssertExpr(), StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | if (StringLiteral *Message = D->getMessage()) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(Message, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitFriendDecl(FriendDecl *D) { | 
|  | if (NamedDecl *FriendD = D->getFriendDecl()) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(FriendD, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } else if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = D->getFriendType()) { | 
|  | if (Visit(TI->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitDeclarationNameInfo(DeclarationNameInfo Name) { | 
|  | switch (Name.getName().getNameKind()) { | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::Identifier: | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName: | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName: | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName: | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::CXXUsingDirective: | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName: | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName: | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName: | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = Name.getNamedTypeInfo()) | 
|  | return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::ObjCZeroArgSelector: | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::ObjCOneArgSelector: | 
|  | case clang::DeclarationName::ObjCMultiArgSelector: | 
|  | // FIXME: Per-identifier location info? | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Invalid DeclarationName::Kind!"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, | 
|  | SourceRange Range) { | 
|  | // FIXME: This whole routine is a hack to work around the lack of proper | 
|  | // source information in nested-name-specifiers (PR5791). Since we do have | 
|  | // a beginning source location, we can visit the first component of the | 
|  | // nested-name-specifier, if it's a single-token component. | 
|  | if (!NNS) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Get the first component in the nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | while (NestedNameSpecifier *Prefix = NNS->getPrefix()) | 
|  | NNS = Prefix; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (NNS->getKind()) { | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace: | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(NNS->getAsNamespace(), Range.getBegin(), | 
|  | TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias: | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias(), | 
|  | Range.getBegin(), TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec: { | 
|  | // If the type has a form where we know that the beginning of the source | 
|  | // range matches up with a reference cursor. Visit the appropriate reference | 
|  | // cursor. | 
|  | const Type *T = NNS->getAsType(); | 
|  | if (const TypedefType *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T)) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(Typedef->getDecl(), Range.getBegin(), TU)); | 
|  | if (const TagType *Tag = dyn_cast<TagType>(T)) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(Tag->getDecl(), Range.getBegin(), TU)); | 
|  | if (const TemplateSpecializationType *TST | 
|  | = dyn_cast<TemplateSpecializationType>(T)) | 
|  | return VisitTemplateName(TST->getTemplateName(), Range.getBegin()); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::Global: | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier: | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::Super: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool | 
|  | CursorVisitor::VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Qualifier) { | 
|  | SmallVector<NestedNameSpecifierLoc, 4> Qualifiers; | 
|  | for (; Qualifier; Qualifier = Qualifier.getPrefix()) | 
|  | Qualifiers.push_back(Qualifier); | 
|  |  | 
|  | while (!Qualifiers.empty()) { | 
|  | NestedNameSpecifierLoc Q = Qualifiers.pop_back_val(); | 
|  | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Q.getNestedNameSpecifier(); | 
|  | switch (NNS->getKind()) { | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace: | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(NNS->getAsNamespace(), | 
|  | Q.getLocalBeginLoc(), | 
|  | TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias: | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorNamespaceRef(NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias(), | 
|  | Q.getLocalBeginLoc(), | 
|  | TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec: | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: | 
|  | if (Visit(Q.getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::Global: | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier: | 
|  | case NestedNameSpecifier::Super: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateParameters( | 
|  | const TemplateParameterList *Params) { | 
|  | if (!Params) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(), | 
|  | PEnd = Params->end(); | 
|  | P != PEnd; ++P) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(*P, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateName(TemplateName Name, SourceLocation Loc) { | 
|  | switch (Name.getKind()) { | 
|  | case TemplateName::Template: | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef(Name.getAsTemplateDecl(), Loc, TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: | 
|  | // Visit the overloaded template set. | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(Name, Loc, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: | 
|  | // FIXME: Visit nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate: | 
|  | // FIXME: Visit nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef( | 
|  | Name.getAsQualifiedTemplateName()->getDecl(), | 
|  | Loc, TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef( | 
|  | Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm()->getParameter(), | 
|  | Loc, TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef( | 
|  | Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack()->getParameterPack(), | 
|  | Loc, TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Invalid TemplateName::Kind!"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(const TemplateArgumentLoc &TAL) { | 
|  | switch (TAL.getArgument().getKind()) { | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::Null: | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::Integral: | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::Pack: | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::Type: | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = TAL.getTypeSourceInfo()) | 
|  | return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::Declaration: | 
|  | if (Expr *E = TAL.getSourceDeclExpression()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(E, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::NullPtr: | 
|  | if (Expr *E = TAL.getSourceNullPtrExpression()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(E, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::Expression: | 
|  | if (Expr *E = TAL.getSourceExpression()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(E, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::Template: | 
|  | case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion: | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TAL.getTemplateQualifierLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitTemplateName(TAL.getArgument().getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern(), | 
|  | TAL.getTemplateNameLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Invalid TemplateArgument::Kind!"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitLinkageSpecDecl(LinkageSpecDecl *D) { | 
|  | return VisitDeclContext(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitQualifiedTypeLoc(QualifiedTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getUnqualifiedLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitBuiltinTypeLoc(BuiltinTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | ASTContext &Context = AU->getASTContext(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Some builtin types (such as Objective-C's "id", "sel", and | 
|  | // "Class") have associated declarations. Create cursors for those. | 
|  | QualType VisitType; | 
|  | switch (TL.getTypePtr()->getKind()) { | 
|  |  | 
|  | case BuiltinType::Void: | 
|  | case BuiltinType::NullPtr: | 
|  | case BuiltinType::Dependent: | 
|  | #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ | 
|  | case BuiltinType::Id: | 
|  | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" | 
|  | case BuiltinType::OCLSampler: | 
|  | case BuiltinType::OCLEvent: | 
|  | case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent: | 
|  | case BuiltinType::OCLQueue: | 
|  | case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID: | 
|  | #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) | 
|  | #define SIGNED_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id: | 
|  | #define UNSIGNED_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id: | 
|  | #define FLOATING_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id: | 
|  | #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id: | 
|  | #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case BuiltinType::ObjCId: | 
|  | VisitType = Context.getObjCIdType(); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case BuiltinType::ObjCClass: | 
|  | VisitType = Context.getObjCClassType(); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case BuiltinType::ObjCSel: | 
|  | VisitType = Context.getObjCSelType(); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!VisitType.isNull()) { | 
|  | if (const TypedefType *Typedef = VisitType->getAs<TypedefType>()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(Typedef->getDecl(), TL.getBuiltinLoc(), | 
|  | TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypedefTypeLoc(TypedefTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getTypedefNameDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitUnresolvedUsingTypeLoc(UnresolvedUsingTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTagTypeLoc(TagTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (TL.isDefinition()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(TL.getDecl(), TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateTypeParmTypeLoc(TemplateTypeParmTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCInterfaceTypeLoc(ObjCInterfaceTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorObjCClassRef(TL.getIFaceDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCTypeParamTypeLoc(ObjCTypeParamTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getLocStart(), TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumProtocols(); I != N; ++I) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(TL.getProtocol(I), TL.getProtocolLoc(I), | 
|  | TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCObjectTypeLoc(ObjCObjectTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (TL.hasBaseTypeAsWritten() && Visit(TL.getBaseLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumTypeArgs(); I != N; ++I) { | 
|  | if (Visit(TL.getTypeArgTInfo(I)->getTypeLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumProtocols(); I != N; ++I) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorObjCProtocolRef(TL.getProtocol(I), TL.getProtocolLoc(I), | 
|  | TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc(ObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitParenTypeLoc(ParenTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getInnerLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitPointerTypeLoc(PointerTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitBlockPointerTypeLoc(BlockPointerTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitMemberPointerTypeLoc(MemberPointerTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitLValueReferenceTypeLoc(LValueReferenceTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitRValueReferenceTypeLoc(RValueReferenceTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getPointeeLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitAttributedTypeLoc(AttributedTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getModifiedLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitFunctionTypeLoc(FunctionTypeLoc TL, | 
|  | bool SkipResultType) { | 
|  | if (!SkipResultType && Visit(TL.getReturnLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumParams(); I != N; ++I) | 
|  | if (Decl *D = TL.getParam(I)) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D, TU, RegionOfInterest))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitArrayTypeLoc(ArrayTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (Visit(TL.getElementLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Expr *Size = TL.getSizeExpr()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(Size, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitDecayedTypeLoc(DecayedTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getOriginalLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitAdjustedTypeLoc(AdjustedTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getOriginalLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitDeducedTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc( | 
|  | DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateName(TL.getTypePtr()->getTemplateName(), | 
|  | TL.getTemplateNameLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc( | 
|  | TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | // Visit the template name. | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateName(TL.getTypePtr()->getTemplateName(), | 
|  | TL.getTemplateNameLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the template arguments. | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumArgs(); I != N; ++I) | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(TL.getArgLoc(I))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypeOfExprTypeLoc(TypeOfExprTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(TL.getUnderlyingExpr(), StmtParent, TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitTypeOfTypeLoc(TypeOfTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = TL.getUnderlyingTInfo()) | 
|  | return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitUnaryTransformTypeLoc(UnaryTransformTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = TL.getUnderlyingTInfo()) | 
|  | return Visit(TSInfo->getTypeLoc()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitDependentNameTypeLoc(DependentNameTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TL.getQualifierLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitDependentTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc( | 
|  | DependentTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | // Visit the nested-name-specifier, if there is one. | 
|  | if (TL.getQualifierLoc() && | 
|  | VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TL.getQualifierLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the template arguments. | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = TL.getNumArgs(); I != N; ++I) | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(TL.getArgLoc(I))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitElaboratedTypeLoc(ElaboratedTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(TL.getQualifierLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getNamedTypeLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitPackExpansionTypeLoc(PackExpansionTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getPatternLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitDecltypeTypeLoc(DecltypeTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | if (Expr *E = TL.getUnderlyingExpr()) | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCXCursor(E, StmtParent, TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitInjectedClassNameTypeLoc(InjectedClassNameTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(TL.getDecl(), TL.getNameLoc(), TU)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitAtomicTypeLoc(AtomicTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getValueLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitPipeTypeLoc(PipeTypeLoc TL) { | 
|  | return Visit(TL.getValueLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(CLASS, PARENT) \ | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::Visit##CLASS##TypeLoc(CLASS##TypeLoc TL) { \ | 
|  | return Visit##PARENT##Loc(TL); \ | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Complex, Type) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(ConstantArray, ArrayType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(IncompleteArray, ArrayType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(VariableArray, ArrayType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(DependentSizedArray, ArrayType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(DependentAddressSpace, Type) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(DependentVector, Type) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(DependentSizedExtVector, Type) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Vector, Type) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(ExtVector, VectorType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(FunctionProto, FunctionType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(FunctionNoProto, FunctionType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Record, TagType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Enum, TagType) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(SubstTemplateTypeParm, Type) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(SubstTemplateTypeParmPack, Type) | 
|  | DEFAULT_TYPELOC_IMPL(Auto, Type) | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitCXXRecordDecl(CXXRecordDecl *D) { | 
|  | // Visit the nested-name-specifier, if present. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = D->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (D->isCompleteDefinition()) { | 
|  | for (const auto &I : D->bases()) { | 
|  | if (Visit(cxcursor::MakeCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(&I, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return VisitTagDecl(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::VisitAttributes(Decl *D) { | 
|  | for (const auto *I : D->attrs()) | 
|  | if (!I->isImplicit() && Visit(MakeCXCursor(I, D, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Data-recursive visitor methods. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | namespace { | 
|  | #define DEF_JOB(NAME, DATA, KIND)\ | 
|  | class NAME : public VisitorJob {\ | 
|  | public:\ | 
|  | NAME(const DATA *d, CXCursor parent) : \ | 
|  | VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::KIND, d) {} \ | 
|  | static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { return VJ->getKind() == KIND; }\ | 
|  | const DATA *get() const { return static_cast<const DATA*>(data[0]); }\ | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | DEF_JOB(StmtVisit, Stmt, StmtVisitKind) | 
|  | DEF_JOB(MemberExprParts, MemberExpr, MemberExprPartsKind) | 
|  | DEF_JOB(DeclRefExprParts, DeclRefExpr, DeclRefExprPartsKind) | 
|  | DEF_JOB(OverloadExprParts, OverloadExpr, OverloadExprPartsKind) | 
|  | DEF_JOB(SizeOfPackExprParts, SizeOfPackExpr, SizeOfPackExprPartsKind) | 
|  | DEF_JOB(LambdaExprParts, LambdaExpr, LambdaExprPartsKind) | 
|  | DEF_JOB(PostChildrenVisit, void, PostChildrenVisitKind) | 
|  | #undef DEF_JOB | 
|  |  | 
|  | class ExplicitTemplateArgsVisit : public VisitorJob { | 
|  | public: | 
|  | ExplicitTemplateArgsVisit(const TemplateArgumentLoc *Begin, | 
|  | const TemplateArgumentLoc *End, CXCursor parent) | 
|  | : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::ExplicitTemplateArgsVisitKind, Begin, | 
|  | End) {} | 
|  | static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { | 
|  | return VJ->getKind() == ExplicitTemplateArgsVisitKind; | 
|  | } | 
|  | const TemplateArgumentLoc *begin() const { | 
|  | return static_cast<const TemplateArgumentLoc *>(data[0]); | 
|  | } | 
|  | const TemplateArgumentLoc *end() { | 
|  | return static_cast<const TemplateArgumentLoc *>(data[1]); | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  | class DeclVisit : public VisitorJob { | 
|  | public: | 
|  | DeclVisit(const Decl *D, CXCursor parent, bool isFirst) : | 
|  | VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::DeclVisitKind, | 
|  | D, isFirst ? (void*) 1 : (void*) nullptr) {} | 
|  | static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { | 
|  | return VJ->getKind() == DeclVisitKind; | 
|  | } | 
|  | const Decl *get() const { return static_cast<const Decl *>(data[0]); } | 
|  | bool isFirst() const { return data[1] != nullptr; } | 
|  | }; | 
|  | class TypeLocVisit : public VisitorJob { | 
|  | public: | 
|  | TypeLocVisit(TypeLoc tl, CXCursor parent) : | 
|  | VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::TypeLocVisitKind, | 
|  | tl.getType().getAsOpaquePtr(), tl.getOpaqueData()) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { | 
|  | return VJ->getKind() == TypeLocVisitKind; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | TypeLoc get() const { | 
|  | QualType T = QualType::getFromOpaquePtr(data[0]); | 
|  | return TypeLoc(T, const_cast<void *>(data[1])); | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | class LabelRefVisit : public VisitorJob { | 
|  | public: | 
|  | LabelRefVisit(LabelDecl *LD, SourceLocation labelLoc, CXCursor parent) | 
|  | : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::LabelRefVisitKind, LD, | 
|  | labelLoc.getPtrEncoding()) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { | 
|  | return VJ->getKind() == VisitorJob::LabelRefVisitKind; | 
|  | } | 
|  | const LabelDecl *get() const { | 
|  | return static_cast<const LabelDecl *>(data[0]); | 
|  | } | 
|  | SourceLocation getLoc() const { | 
|  | return SourceLocation::getFromPtrEncoding(data[1]); } | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | class NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit : public VisitorJob { | 
|  | public: | 
|  | NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Qualifier, CXCursor parent) | 
|  | : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::NestedNameSpecifierLocVisitKind, | 
|  | Qualifier.getNestedNameSpecifier(), | 
|  | Qualifier.getOpaqueData()) { } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { | 
|  | return VJ->getKind() == VisitorJob::NestedNameSpecifierLocVisitKind; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | NestedNameSpecifierLoc get() const { | 
|  | return NestedNameSpecifierLoc( | 
|  | const_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>( | 
|  | static_cast<const NestedNameSpecifier *>(data[0])), | 
|  | const_cast<void *>(data[1])); | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | class DeclarationNameInfoVisit : public VisitorJob { | 
|  | public: | 
|  | DeclarationNameInfoVisit(const Stmt *S, CXCursor parent) | 
|  | : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::DeclarationNameInfoVisitKind, S) {} | 
|  | static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { | 
|  | return VJ->getKind() == VisitorJob::DeclarationNameInfoVisitKind; | 
|  | } | 
|  | DeclarationNameInfo get() const { | 
|  | const Stmt *S = static_cast<const Stmt *>(data[0]); | 
|  | switch (S->getStmtClass()) { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Unhandled Stmt"); | 
|  | case clang::Stmt::MSDependentExistsStmtClass: | 
|  | return cast<MSDependentExistsStmt>(S)->getNameInfo(); | 
|  | case Stmt::CXXDependentScopeMemberExprClass: | 
|  | return cast<CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr>(S)->getMemberNameInfo(); | 
|  | case Stmt::DependentScopeDeclRefExprClass: | 
|  | return cast<DependentScopeDeclRefExpr>(S)->getNameInfo(); | 
|  | case Stmt::OMPCriticalDirectiveClass: | 
|  | return cast<OMPCriticalDirective>(S)->getDirectiveName(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  | class MemberRefVisit : public VisitorJob { | 
|  | public: | 
|  | MemberRefVisit(const FieldDecl *D, SourceLocation L, CXCursor parent) | 
|  | : VisitorJob(parent, VisitorJob::MemberRefVisitKind, D, | 
|  | L.getPtrEncoding()) {} | 
|  | static bool classof(const VisitorJob *VJ) { | 
|  | return VJ->getKind() == VisitorJob::MemberRefVisitKind; | 
|  | } | 
|  | const FieldDecl *get() const { | 
|  | return static_cast<const FieldDecl *>(data[0]); | 
|  | } | 
|  | SourceLocation getLoc() const { | 
|  | return SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding((unsigned)(uintptr_t) data[1]); | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  | class EnqueueVisitor : public ConstStmtVisitor<EnqueueVisitor, void> { | 
|  | friend class OMPClauseEnqueue; | 
|  | VisitorWorkList &WL; | 
|  | CXCursor Parent; | 
|  | public: | 
|  | EnqueueVisitor(VisitorWorkList &wl, CXCursor parent) | 
|  | : WL(wl), Parent(parent) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void VisitAddrLabelExpr(const AddrLabelExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitBlockExpr(const BlockExpr *B); | 
|  | void VisitCompoundLiteralExpr(const CompoundLiteralExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCompoundStmt(const CompoundStmt *S); | 
|  | void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(const CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) { /* Do nothing. */ } | 
|  | void VisitMSDependentExistsStmt(const MSDependentExistsStmt *S); | 
|  | void VisitCXXDependentScopeMemberExpr(const CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXNewExpr(const CXXNewExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXScalarValueInitExpr(const CXXScalarValueInitExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(const CXXOperatorCallExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXPseudoDestructorExpr(const CXXPseudoDestructorExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXTemporaryObjectExpr(const CXXTemporaryObjectExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXTypeidExpr(const CXXTypeidExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXUnresolvedConstructExpr(const CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXUuidofExpr(const CXXUuidofExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitCXXCatchStmt(const CXXCatchStmt *S); | 
|  | void VisitCXXForRangeStmt(const CXXForRangeStmt *S); | 
|  | void VisitDeclRefExpr(const DeclRefExpr *D); | 
|  | void VisitDeclStmt(const DeclStmt *S); | 
|  | void VisitDependentScopeDeclRefExpr(const DependentScopeDeclRefExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitDesignatedInitExpr(const DesignatedInitExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitExplicitCastExpr(const ExplicitCastExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitForStmt(const ForStmt *FS); | 
|  | void VisitGotoStmt(const GotoStmt *GS); | 
|  | void VisitIfStmt(const IfStmt *If); | 
|  | void VisitInitListExpr(const InitListExpr *IE); | 
|  | void VisitMemberExpr(const MemberExpr *M); | 
|  | void VisitOffsetOfExpr(const OffsetOfExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitObjCEncodeExpr(const ObjCEncodeExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitObjCMessageExpr(const ObjCMessageExpr *M); | 
|  | void VisitOverloadExpr(const OverloadExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(const UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitStmt(const Stmt *S); | 
|  | void VisitSwitchStmt(const SwitchStmt *S); | 
|  | void VisitWhileStmt(const WhileStmt *W); | 
|  | void VisitTypeTraitExpr(const TypeTraitExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitArrayTypeTraitExpr(const ArrayTypeTraitExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitExpressionTraitExpr(const ExpressionTraitExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitUnresolvedMemberExpr(const UnresolvedMemberExpr *U); | 
|  | void VisitVAArgExpr(const VAArgExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitSizeOfPackExpr(const SizeOfPackExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitPseudoObjectExpr(const PseudoObjectExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitOpaqueValueExpr(const OpaqueValueExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitLambdaExpr(const LambdaExpr *E); | 
|  | void VisitOMPExecutableDirective(const OMPExecutableDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPLoopDirective(const OMPLoopDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPParallelDirective(const OMPParallelDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPSimdDirective(const OMPSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPForDirective(const OMPForDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPForSimdDirective(const OMPForSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPSectionsDirective(const OMPSectionsDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPSectionDirective(const OMPSectionDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPSingleDirective(const OMPSingleDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPMasterDirective(const OMPMasterDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPCriticalDirective(const OMPCriticalDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPParallelForDirective(const OMPParallelForDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPParallelForSimdDirective(const OMPParallelForSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPParallelSectionsDirective(const OMPParallelSectionsDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTaskDirective(const OMPTaskDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTaskyieldDirective(const OMPTaskyieldDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPBarrierDirective(const OMPBarrierDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTaskwaitDirective(const OMPTaskwaitDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTaskgroupDirective(const OMPTaskgroupDirective *D); | 
|  | void | 
|  | VisitOMPCancellationPointDirective(const OMPCancellationPointDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPCancelDirective(const OMPCancelDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPFlushDirective(const OMPFlushDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPOrderedDirective(const OMPOrderedDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPAtomicDirective(const OMPAtomicDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetDirective(const OMPTargetDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetDataDirective(const OMPTargetDataDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetEnterDataDirective(const OMPTargetEnterDataDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetExitDataDirective(const OMPTargetExitDataDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetParallelDirective(const OMPTargetParallelDirective *D); | 
|  | void | 
|  | VisitOMPTargetParallelForDirective(const OMPTargetParallelForDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTeamsDirective(const OMPTeamsDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTaskLoopDirective(const OMPTaskLoopDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTaskLoopSimdDirective(const OMPTaskLoopSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPDistributeDirective(const OMPDistributeDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPDistributeParallelForDirective( | 
|  | const OMPDistributeParallelForDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPDistributeSimdDirective(const OMPDistributeSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetSimdDirective(const OMPTargetSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTeamsDistributeDirective(const OMPTeamsDistributeDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDirective(const OMPTargetTeamsDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D); | 
|  | void VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective *D); | 
|  |  | 
|  | private: | 
|  | void AddDeclarationNameInfo(const Stmt *S); | 
|  | void AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Qualifier); | 
|  | void AddExplicitTemplateArgs(const TemplateArgumentLoc *A, | 
|  | unsigned NumTemplateArgs); | 
|  | void AddMemberRef(const FieldDecl *D, SourceLocation L); | 
|  | void AddStmt(const Stmt *S); | 
|  | void AddDecl(const Decl *D, bool isFirst = true); | 
|  | void AddTypeLoc(TypeSourceInfo *TI); | 
|  | void EnqueueChildren(const Stmt *S); | 
|  | void EnqueueChildren(const OMPClause *S); | 
|  | }; | 
|  | } // end anonyous namespace | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::AddDeclarationNameInfo(const Stmt *S) { | 
|  | // 'S' should always be non-null, since it comes from the | 
|  | // statement we are visiting. | 
|  | WL.push_back(DeclarationNameInfoVisit(S, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | EnqueueVisitor::AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc Qualifier) { | 
|  | if (Qualifier) | 
|  | WL.push_back(NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit(Qualifier, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::AddStmt(const Stmt *S) { | 
|  | if (S) | 
|  | WL.push_back(StmtVisit(S, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::AddDecl(const Decl *D, bool isFirst) { | 
|  | if (D) | 
|  | WL.push_back(DeclVisit(D, Parent, isFirst)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::AddExplicitTemplateArgs(const TemplateArgumentLoc *A, | 
|  | unsigned NumTemplateArgs) { | 
|  | WL.push_back(ExplicitTemplateArgsVisit(A, A + NumTemplateArgs, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::AddMemberRef(const FieldDecl *D, SourceLocation L) { | 
|  | if (D) | 
|  | WL.push_back(MemberRefVisit(D, L, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::AddTypeLoc(TypeSourceInfo *TI) { | 
|  | if (TI) | 
|  | WL.push_back(TypeLocVisit(TI->getTypeLoc(), Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::EnqueueChildren(const Stmt *S) { | 
|  | unsigned size = WL.size(); | 
|  | for (const Stmt *SubStmt : S->children()) { | 
|  | AddStmt(SubStmt); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (size == WL.size()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | // Now reverse the entries we just added.  This will match the DFS | 
|  | // ordering performed by the worklist. | 
|  | VisitorWorkList::iterator I = WL.begin() + size, E = WL.end(); | 
|  | std::reverse(I, E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | namespace { | 
|  | class OMPClauseEnqueue : public ConstOMPClauseVisitor<OMPClauseEnqueue> { | 
|  | EnqueueVisitor *Visitor; | 
|  | /// Process clauses with list of variables. | 
|  | template <typename T> | 
|  | void VisitOMPClauseList(T *Node); | 
|  | public: | 
|  | OMPClauseEnqueue(EnqueueVisitor *Visitor) : Visitor(Visitor) { } | 
|  | #define OPENMP_CLAUSE(Name, Class)                                             \ | 
|  | void Visit##Class(const Class *C); | 
|  | #include "clang/Basic/OpenMPKinds.def" | 
|  | void VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(const OMPClauseWithPreInit *C); | 
|  | void VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(const OMPClauseWithPostUpdate *C); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit( | 
|  | const OMPClauseWithPreInit *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getPreInitStmt()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate( | 
|  | const OMPClauseWithPostUpdate *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getPostUpdateExpr()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPIfClause(const OMPIfClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getCondition()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPFinalClause(const OMPFinalClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getCondition()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNumThreadsClause(const OMPNumThreadsClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumThreads()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSafelenClause(const OMPSafelenClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getSafelen()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSimdlenClause(const OMPSimdlenClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getSimdlen()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPCollapseClause(const OMPCollapseClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumForLoops()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDefaultClause(const OMPDefaultClause *C) { } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPProcBindClause(const OMPProcBindClause *C) { } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPScheduleClause(const OMPScheduleClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getChunkSize()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPOrderedClause(const OMPOrderedClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumForLoops()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNowaitClause(const OMPNowaitClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPUntiedClause(const OMPUntiedClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPMergeableClause(const OMPMergeableClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPReadClause(const OMPReadClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPWriteClause(const OMPWriteClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPUpdateClause(const OMPUpdateClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPCaptureClause(const OMPCaptureClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSeqCstClause(const OMPSeqCstClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPThreadsClause(const OMPThreadsClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSIMDClause(const OMPSIMDClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNogroupClause(const OMPNogroupClause *) {} | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDeviceClause(const OMPDeviceClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getDevice()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNumTeamsClause(const OMPNumTeamsClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumTeams()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPThreadLimitClause(const OMPThreadLimitClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getThreadLimit()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPPriorityClause(const OMPPriorityClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getPriority()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPGrainsizeClause(const OMPGrainsizeClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getGrainsize()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPNumTasksClause(const OMPNumTasksClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getNumTasks()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPHintClause(const OMPHintClause *C) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getHint()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | template<typename T> | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPClauseList(T *Node) { | 
|  | for (const auto *I : Node->varlists()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(I); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPPrivateClause(const OMPPrivateClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | for (const auto *E : C->private_copies()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPFirstprivateClause( | 
|  | const OMPFirstprivateClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C); | 
|  | for (const auto *E : C->private_copies()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (const auto *E : C->inits()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPLastprivateClause( | 
|  | const OMPLastprivateClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C); | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->private_copies()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->source_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->destination_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->assignment_ops()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPSharedClause(const OMPSharedClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPReductionClause(const OMPReductionClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C); | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->privates()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->lhs_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->rhs_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->reduction_ops()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPTaskReductionClause( | 
|  | const OMPTaskReductionClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C); | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->privates()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->lhs_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->rhs_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->reduction_ops()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPInReductionClause( | 
|  | const OMPInReductionClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C); | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->privates()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->lhs_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->rhs_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->reduction_ops()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->taskgroup_descriptors()) | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPLinearClause(const OMPLinearClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPostUpdate(C); | 
|  | for (const auto *E : C->privates()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (const auto *E : C->inits()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (const auto *E : C->updates()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (const auto *E : C->finals()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getStep()); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getCalcStep()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPAlignedClause(const OMPAlignedClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getAlignment()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPCopyinClause(const OMPCopyinClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->source_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->destination_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->assignment_ops()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | void | 
|  | OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPCopyprivateClause(const OMPCopyprivateClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->source_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->destination_exprs()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | for (auto *E : C->assignment_ops()) { | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPFlushClause(const OMPFlushClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDependClause(const OMPDependClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPMapClause(const OMPMapClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDistScheduleClause( | 
|  | const OMPDistScheduleClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseWithPreInit(C); | 
|  | Visitor->AddStmt(C->getChunkSize()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPDefaultmapClause( | 
|  | const OMPDefaultmapClause * /*C*/) {} | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPToClause(const OMPToClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPFromClause(const OMPFromClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPUseDevicePtrClause(const OMPUseDevicePtrClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void OMPClauseEnqueue::VisitOMPIsDevicePtrClause(const OMPIsDevicePtrClause *C) { | 
|  | VisitOMPClauseList(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::EnqueueChildren(const OMPClause *S) { | 
|  | unsigned size = WL.size(); | 
|  | OMPClauseEnqueue Visitor(this); | 
|  | Visitor.Visit(S); | 
|  | if (size == WL.size()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | // Now reverse the entries we just added.  This will match the DFS | 
|  | // ordering performed by the worklist. | 
|  | VisitorWorkList::iterator I = WL.begin() + size, E = WL.end(); | 
|  | std::reverse(I, E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitAddrLabelExpr(const AddrLabelExpr *E) { | 
|  | WL.push_back(LabelRefVisit(E->getLabel(), E->getLabelLoc(), Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitBlockExpr(const BlockExpr *B) { | 
|  | AddDecl(B->getBlockDecl()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCompoundLiteralExpr(const CompoundLiteralExpr *E) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(E); | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCompoundStmt(const CompoundStmt *S) { | 
|  | for (auto &I : llvm::reverse(S->body())) | 
|  | AddStmt(I); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor:: | 
|  | VisitMSDependentExistsStmt(const MSDependentExistsStmt *S) { | 
|  | AddStmt(S->getSubStmt()); | 
|  | AddDeclarationNameInfo(S); | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = S->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor:: | 
|  | VisitCXXDependentScopeMemberExpr(const CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *E) { | 
|  | if (E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) | 
|  | AddExplicitTemplateArgs(E->getTemplateArgs(), E->getNumTemplateArgs()); | 
|  | AddDeclarationNameInfo(E); | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = E->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc); | 
|  | if (!E->isImplicitAccess()) | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getBase()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXNewExpr(const CXXNewExpr *E) { | 
|  | // Enqueue the initializer , if any. | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getInitializer()); | 
|  | // Enqueue the array size, if any. | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getArraySize()); | 
|  | // Enqueue the allocated type. | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getAllocatedTypeSourceInfo()); | 
|  | // Enqueue the placement arguments. | 
|  | for (unsigned I = E->getNumPlacementArgs(); I > 0; --I) | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getPlacementArg(I-1)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(const CXXOperatorCallExpr *CE) { | 
|  | for (unsigned I = CE->getNumArgs(); I > 1 /* Yes, this is 1 */; --I) | 
|  | AddStmt(CE->getArg(I-1)); | 
|  | AddStmt(CE->getCallee()); | 
|  | AddStmt(CE->getArg(0)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXPseudoDestructorExpr( | 
|  | const CXXPseudoDestructorExpr *E) { | 
|  | // Visit the name of the type being destroyed. | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getDestroyedTypeInfo()); | 
|  | // Visit the scope type that looks disturbingly like the nested-name-specifier | 
|  | // but isn't. | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getScopeTypeInfo()); | 
|  | // Visit the nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = E->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc); | 
|  | // Visit base expression. | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getBase()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXScalarValueInitExpr( | 
|  | const CXXScalarValueInitExpr *E) { | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXTemporaryObjectExpr( | 
|  | const CXXTemporaryObjectExpr *E) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(E); | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXTypeidExpr(const CXXTypeidExpr *E) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(E); | 
|  | if (E->isTypeOperand()) | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeOperandSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXUnresolvedConstructExpr( | 
|  | const CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr *E) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(E); | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXUuidofExpr(const CXXUuidofExpr *E) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(E); | 
|  | if (E->isTypeOperand()) | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeOperandSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXCatchStmt(const CXXCatchStmt *S) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(S); | 
|  | AddDecl(S->getExceptionDecl()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitCXXForRangeStmt(const CXXForRangeStmt *S) { | 
|  | AddStmt(S->getBody()); | 
|  | AddStmt(S->getRangeInit()); | 
|  | AddDecl(S->getLoopVariable()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitDeclRefExpr(const DeclRefExpr *DR) { | 
|  | if (DR->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) | 
|  | AddExplicitTemplateArgs(DR->getTemplateArgs(), DR->getNumTemplateArgs()); | 
|  | WL.push_back(DeclRefExprParts(DR, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitDependentScopeDeclRefExpr( | 
|  | const DependentScopeDeclRefExpr *E) { | 
|  | if (E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) | 
|  | AddExplicitTemplateArgs(E->getTemplateArgs(), E->getNumTemplateArgs()); | 
|  | AddDeclarationNameInfo(E); | 
|  | AddNestedNameSpecifierLoc(E->getQualifierLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitDeclStmt(const DeclStmt *S) { | 
|  | unsigned size = WL.size(); | 
|  | bool isFirst = true; | 
|  | for (const auto *D : S->decls()) { | 
|  | AddDecl(D, isFirst); | 
|  | isFirst = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (size == WL.size()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | // Now reverse the entries we just added.  This will match the DFS | 
|  | // ordering performed by the worklist. | 
|  | VisitorWorkList::iterator I = WL.begin() + size, E = WL.end(); | 
|  | std::reverse(I, E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitDesignatedInitExpr(const DesignatedInitExpr *E) { | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getInit()); | 
|  | for (const DesignatedInitExpr::Designator &D : | 
|  | llvm::reverse(E->designators())) { | 
|  | if (D.isFieldDesignator()) { | 
|  | if (FieldDecl *Field = D.getField()) | 
|  | AddMemberRef(Field, D.getFieldLoc()); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (D.isArrayDesignator()) { | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getArrayIndex(D)); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | assert(D.isArrayRangeDesignator() && "Unknown designator kind"); | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getArrayRangeEnd(D)); | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getArrayRangeStart(D)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitExplicitCastExpr(const ExplicitCastExpr *E) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(E); | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeInfoAsWritten()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitForStmt(const ForStmt *FS) { | 
|  | AddStmt(FS->getBody()); | 
|  | AddStmt(FS->getInc()); | 
|  | AddStmt(FS->getCond()); | 
|  | AddDecl(FS->getConditionVariable()); | 
|  | AddStmt(FS->getInit()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitGotoStmt(const GotoStmt *GS) { | 
|  | WL.push_back(LabelRefVisit(GS->getLabel(), GS->getLabelLoc(), Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitIfStmt(const IfStmt *If) { | 
|  | AddStmt(If->getElse()); | 
|  | AddStmt(If->getThen()); | 
|  | AddStmt(If->getCond()); | 
|  | AddDecl(If->getConditionVariable()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitInitListExpr(const InitListExpr *IE) { | 
|  | // We care about the syntactic form of the initializer list, only. | 
|  | if (InitListExpr *Syntactic = IE->getSyntacticForm()) | 
|  | IE = Syntactic; | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(IE); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitMemberExpr(const MemberExpr *M) { | 
|  | WL.push_back(MemberExprParts(M, Parent)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If the base of the member access expression is an implicit 'this', don't | 
|  | // visit it. | 
|  | // FIXME: If we ever want to show these implicit accesses, this will be | 
|  | // unfortunate. However, clang_getCursor() relies on this behavior. | 
|  | if (M->isImplicitAccess()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Ignore base anonymous struct/union fields, otherwise they will shadow the | 
|  | // real field that we are interested in. | 
|  | if (auto *SubME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(M->getBase())) { | 
|  | if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(SubME->getMemberDecl())) { | 
|  | if (FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) { | 
|  | AddStmt(SubME->getBase()); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | AddStmt(M->getBase()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitObjCEncodeExpr(const ObjCEncodeExpr *E) { | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getEncodedTypeSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitObjCMessageExpr(const ObjCMessageExpr *M) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(M); | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(M->getClassReceiverTypeInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOffsetOfExpr(const OffsetOfExpr *E) { | 
|  | // Visit the components of the offsetof expression. | 
|  | for (unsigned N = E->getNumComponents(), I = N; I > 0; --I) { | 
|  | const OffsetOfNode &Node = E->getComponent(I-1); | 
|  | switch (Node.getKind()) { | 
|  | case OffsetOfNode::Array: | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getIndexExpr(Node.getArrayExprIndex())); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case OffsetOfNode::Field: | 
|  | AddMemberRef(Node.getField(), Node.getSourceRange().getEnd()); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case OffsetOfNode::Identifier: | 
|  | case OffsetOfNode::Base: | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | // Visit the type into which we're computing the offset. | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getTypeSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOverloadExpr(const OverloadExpr *E) { | 
|  | if (E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) | 
|  | AddExplicitTemplateArgs(E->getTemplateArgs(), E->getNumTemplateArgs()); | 
|  | WL.push_back(OverloadExprParts(E, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( | 
|  | const UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr *E) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(E); | 
|  | if (E->isArgumentType()) | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getArgumentTypeInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitStmt(const Stmt *S) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(S); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitSwitchStmt(const SwitchStmt *S) { | 
|  | AddStmt(S->getBody()); | 
|  | AddStmt(S->getCond()); | 
|  | AddDecl(S->getConditionVariable()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitWhileStmt(const WhileStmt *W) { | 
|  | AddStmt(W->getBody()); | 
|  | AddStmt(W->getCond()); | 
|  | AddDecl(W->getConditionVariable()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitTypeTraitExpr(const TypeTraitExpr *E) { | 
|  | for (unsigned I = E->getNumArgs(); I > 0; --I) | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getArg(I-1)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitArrayTypeTraitExpr(const ArrayTypeTraitExpr *E) { | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getQueriedTypeSourceInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitExpressionTraitExpr(const ExpressionTraitExpr *E) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitUnresolvedMemberExpr(const UnresolvedMemberExpr *U) { | 
|  | VisitOverloadExpr(U); | 
|  | if (!U->isImplicitAccess()) | 
|  | AddStmt(U->getBase()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitVAArgExpr(const VAArgExpr *E) { | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getSubExpr()); | 
|  | AddTypeLoc(E->getWrittenTypeInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitSizeOfPackExpr(const SizeOfPackExpr *E) { | 
|  | WL.push_back(SizeOfPackExprParts(E, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOpaqueValueExpr(const OpaqueValueExpr *E) { | 
|  | // If the opaque value has a source expression, just transparently | 
|  | // visit that.  This is useful for (e.g.) pseudo-object expressions. | 
|  | if (Expr *SourceExpr = E->getSourceExpr()) | 
|  | return Visit(SourceExpr); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitLambdaExpr(const LambdaExpr *E) { | 
|  | AddStmt(E->getBody()); | 
|  | WL.push_back(LambdaExprParts(E, Parent)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitPseudoObjectExpr(const PseudoObjectExpr *E) { | 
|  | // Treat the expression like its syntactic form. | 
|  | Visit(E->getSyntacticForm()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPExecutableDirective( | 
|  | const OMPExecutableDirective *D) { | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(D); | 
|  | for (ArrayRef<OMPClause *>::iterator I = D->clauses().begin(), | 
|  | E = D->clauses().end(); | 
|  | I != E; ++I) | 
|  | EnqueueChildren(*I); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPLoopDirective(const OMPLoopDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelDirective(const OMPParallelDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPSimdDirective(const OMPSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPForDirective(const OMPForDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPForSimdDirective(const OMPForSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPSectionsDirective(const OMPSectionsDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPSectionDirective(const OMPSectionDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPSingleDirective(const OMPSingleDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPMasterDirective(const OMPMasterDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPCriticalDirective(const OMPCriticalDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | AddDeclarationNameInfo(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelForDirective(const OMPParallelForDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPParallelForSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPParallelSectionsDirective( | 
|  | const OMPParallelSectionsDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskDirective(const OMPTaskDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void | 
|  | EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskyieldDirective(const OMPTaskyieldDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPBarrierDirective(const OMPBarrierDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskwaitDirective(const OMPTaskwaitDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskgroupDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTaskgroupDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | if (const Expr *E = D->getReductionRef()) | 
|  | VisitStmt(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPFlushDirective(const OMPFlushDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPOrderedDirective(const OMPOrderedDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPAtomicDirective(const OMPAtomicDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetDirective(const OMPTargetDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetDataDirective(const | 
|  | OMPTargetDataDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetEnterDataDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetEnterDataDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetExitDataDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetExitDataDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetParallelDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetParallelDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetParallelForDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetParallelForDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDirective(const OMPTeamsDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPCancellationPointDirective( | 
|  | const OMPCancellationPointDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPCancelDirective(const OMPCancelDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskLoopDirective(const OMPTaskLoopDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTaskLoopSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTaskLoopSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDistributeDirective( | 
|  | const OMPDistributeDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDistributeParallelForDirective( | 
|  | const OMPDistributeParallelForDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPDistributeSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPDistributeSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDistributeDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTeamsDistributeDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPExecutableDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void EnqueueVisitor::VisitOMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective( | 
|  | const OMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective *D) { | 
|  | VisitOMPLoopDirective(D); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void CursorVisitor::EnqueueWorkList(VisitorWorkList &WL, const Stmt *S) { | 
|  | EnqueueVisitor(WL, MakeCXCursor(S, StmtParent, TU,RegionOfInterest)).Visit(S); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::IsInRegionOfInterest(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (RegionOfInterest.isValid()) { | 
|  | SourceRange Range = getRawCursorExtent(C); | 
|  | if (Range.isInvalid() || CompareRegionOfInterest(Range)) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::RunVisitorWorkList(VisitorWorkList &WL) { | 
|  | while (!WL.empty()) { | 
|  | // Dequeue the worklist item. | 
|  | VisitorJob LI = WL.pop_back_val(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Set the Parent field, then back to its old value once we're done. | 
|  | SetParentRAII SetParent(Parent, StmtParent, LI.getParent()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (LI.getKind()) { | 
|  | case VisitorJob::DeclVisitKind: { | 
|  | const Decl *D = cast<DeclVisit>(&LI)->get(); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // For now, perform default visitation for Decls. | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(D, TU, RegionOfInterest, | 
|  | cast<DeclVisit>(&LI)->isFirst()))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::ExplicitTemplateArgsVisitKind: { | 
|  | for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : | 
|  | *cast<ExplicitTemplateArgsVisit>(&LI)) { | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(Arg)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::TypeLocVisitKind: { | 
|  | // Perform default visitation for TypeLocs. | 
|  | if (Visit(cast<TypeLocVisit>(&LI)->get())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::LabelRefVisitKind: { | 
|  | const LabelDecl *LS = cast<LabelRefVisit>(&LI)->get(); | 
|  | if (LabelStmt *stmt = LS->getStmt()) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorLabelRef(stmt, cast<LabelRefVisit>(&LI)->getLoc(), | 
|  | TU))) { | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case VisitorJob::NestedNameSpecifierLocVisitKind: { | 
|  | NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit *V = cast<NestedNameSpecifierLocVisit>(&LI); | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(V->get())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case VisitorJob::DeclarationNameInfoVisitKind: { | 
|  | if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(cast<DeclarationNameInfoVisit>(&LI) | 
|  | ->get())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::MemberRefVisitKind: { | 
|  | MemberRefVisit *V = cast<MemberRefVisit>(&LI); | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorMemberRef(V->get(), V->getLoc(), TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::StmtVisitKind: { | 
|  | const Stmt *S = cast<StmtVisit>(&LI)->get(); | 
|  | if (!S) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Update the current cursor. | 
|  | CXCursor Cursor = MakeCXCursor(S, StmtParent, TU, RegionOfInterest); | 
|  | if (!IsInRegionOfInterest(Cursor)) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | switch (Visitor(Cursor, Parent, ClientData)) { | 
|  | case CXChildVisit_Break: return true; | 
|  | case CXChildVisit_Continue: break; | 
|  | case CXChildVisit_Recurse: | 
|  | if (PostChildrenVisitor) | 
|  | WL.push_back(PostChildrenVisit(nullptr, Cursor)); | 
|  | EnqueueWorkList(WL, S); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::MemberExprPartsKind: { | 
|  | // Handle the other pieces in the MemberExpr besides the base. | 
|  | const MemberExpr *M = cast<MemberExprParts>(&LI)->get(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the nested-name-specifier | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = M->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the declaration name. | 
|  | if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(M->getMemberNameInfo())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit the explicitly-specified template arguments, if any. | 
|  | if (M->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { | 
|  | for (const TemplateArgumentLoc *Arg = M->getTemplateArgs(), | 
|  | *ArgEnd = Arg + M->getNumTemplateArgs(); | 
|  | Arg != ArgEnd; ++Arg) { | 
|  | if (VisitTemplateArgumentLoc(*Arg)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::DeclRefExprPartsKind: { | 
|  | const DeclRefExpr *DR = cast<DeclRefExprParts>(&LI)->get(); | 
|  | // Visit nested-name-specifier, if present. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = DR->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | // Visit declaration name. | 
|  | if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(DR->getNameInfo())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::OverloadExprPartsKind: { | 
|  | const OverloadExpr *O = cast<OverloadExprParts>(&LI)->get(); | 
|  | // Visit the nested-name-specifier. | 
|  | if (NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = O->getQualifierLoc()) | 
|  | if (VisitNestedNameSpecifierLoc(QualifierLoc)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | // Visit the declaration name. | 
|  | if (VisitDeclarationNameInfo(O->getNameInfo())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | // Visit the overloaded declaration reference. | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(O, TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | case VisitorJob::SizeOfPackExprPartsKind: { | 
|  | const SizeOfPackExpr *E = cast<SizeOfPackExprParts>(&LI)->get(); | 
|  | NamedDecl *Pack = E->getPack(); | 
|  | if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Pack)) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorTypeRef(cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Pack), | 
|  | E->getPackLoc(), TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Pack)) { | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorTemplateRef(cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Pack), | 
|  | E->getPackLoc(), TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Non-type template parameter packs and function parameter packs are | 
|  | // treated like DeclRefExpr cursors. | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case VisitorJob::LambdaExprPartsKind: { | 
|  | // Visit captures. | 
|  | const LambdaExpr *E = cast<LambdaExprParts>(&LI)->get(); | 
|  | for (LambdaExpr::capture_iterator C = E->explicit_capture_begin(), | 
|  | CEnd = E->explicit_capture_end(); | 
|  | C != CEnd; ++C) { | 
|  | // FIXME: Lambda init-captures. | 
|  | if (!C->capturesVariable()) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCursorVariableRef(C->getCapturedVar(), | 
|  | C->getLocation(), | 
|  | TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Visit parameters and return type, if present. | 
|  | if (E->hasExplicitParameters() || E->hasExplicitResultType()) { | 
|  | TypeLoc TL = E->getCallOperator()->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); | 
|  | if (E->hasExplicitParameters() && E->hasExplicitResultType()) { | 
|  | // Visit the whole type. | 
|  | if (Visit(TL)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } else if (FunctionProtoTypeLoc Proto = | 
|  | TL.getAs<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>()) { | 
|  | if (E->hasExplicitParameters()) { | 
|  | // Visit parameters. | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = Proto.getNumParams(); I != N; ++I) | 
|  | if (Visit(MakeCXCursor(Proto.getParam(I), TU))) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | // Visit result type. | 
|  | if (Visit(Proto.getReturnLoc())) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case VisitorJob::PostChildrenVisitKind: | 
|  | if (PostChildrenVisitor(Parent, ClientData)) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool CursorVisitor::Visit(const Stmt *S) { | 
|  | VisitorWorkList *WL = nullptr; | 
|  | if (!WorkListFreeList.empty()) { | 
|  | WL = WorkListFreeList.back(); | 
|  | WL->clear(); | 
|  | WorkListFreeList.pop_back(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | else { | 
|  | WL = new VisitorWorkList(); | 
|  | WorkListCache.push_back(WL); | 
|  | } | 
|  | EnqueueWorkList(*WL, S); | 
|  | bool result = RunVisitorWorkList(*WL); | 
|  | WorkListFreeList.push_back(WL); | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | namespace { | 
|  | typedef SmallVector<SourceRange, 4> RefNamePieces; | 
|  | RefNamePieces buildPieces(unsigned NameFlags, bool IsMemberRefExpr, | 
|  | const DeclarationNameInfo &NI, SourceRange QLoc, | 
|  | const SourceRange *TemplateArgsLoc = nullptr) { | 
|  | const bool WantQualifier = NameFlags & CXNameRange_WantQualifier; | 
|  | const bool WantTemplateArgs = NameFlags & CXNameRange_WantTemplateArgs; | 
|  | const bool WantSinglePiece = NameFlags & CXNameRange_WantSinglePiece; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const DeclarationName::NameKind Kind = NI.getName().getNameKind(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | RefNamePieces Pieces; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (WantQualifier && QLoc.isValid()) | 
|  | Pieces.push_back(QLoc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Kind != DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName || IsMemberRefExpr) | 
|  | Pieces.push_back(NI.getLoc()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (WantTemplateArgs && TemplateArgsLoc && TemplateArgsLoc->isValid()) | 
|  | Pieces.push_back(*TemplateArgsLoc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Kind == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) { | 
|  | Pieces.push_back(SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding( | 
|  | NI.getInfo().CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc)); | 
|  | Pieces.push_back(SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding( | 
|  | NI.getInfo().CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (WantSinglePiece) { | 
|  | SourceRange R(Pieces.front().getBegin(), Pieces.back().getEnd()); | 
|  | Pieces.clear(); | 
|  | Pieces.push_back(R); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Pieces; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Misc. API hooks. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void fatal_error_handler(void *user_data, const std::string& reason, | 
|  | bool gen_crash_diag) { | 
|  | // Write the result out to stderr avoiding errs() because raw_ostreams can | 
|  | // call report_fatal_error. | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "LIBCLANG FATAL ERROR: %s\n", reason.c_str()); | 
|  | ::abort(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | namespace { | 
|  | struct RegisterFatalErrorHandler { | 
|  | RegisterFatalErrorHandler() { | 
|  | llvm::install_fatal_error_handler(fatal_error_handler, nullptr); | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static llvm::ManagedStatic<RegisterFatalErrorHandler> RegisterFatalErrorHandlerOnce; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXIndex clang_createIndex(int excludeDeclarationsFromPCH, | 
|  | int displayDiagnostics) { | 
|  | // We use crash recovery to make some of our APIs more reliable, implicitly | 
|  | // enable it. | 
|  | if (!getenv("LIBCLANG_DISABLE_CRASH_RECOVERY")) | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContext::Enable(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Look through the managed static to trigger construction of the managed | 
|  | // static which registers our fatal error handler. This ensures it is only | 
|  | // registered once. | 
|  | (void)*RegisterFatalErrorHandlerOnce; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Initialize targets for clang module support. | 
|  | llvm::InitializeAllTargets(); | 
|  | llvm::InitializeAllTargetMCs(); | 
|  | llvm::InitializeAllAsmPrinters(); | 
|  | llvm::InitializeAllAsmParsers(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CIndexer *CIdxr = new CIndexer(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (excludeDeclarationsFromPCH) | 
|  | CIdxr->setOnlyLocalDecls(); | 
|  | if (displayDiagnostics) | 
|  | CIdxr->setDisplayDiagnostics(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (getenv("LIBCLANG_BGPRIO_INDEX")) | 
|  | CIdxr->setCXGlobalOptFlags(CIdxr->getCXGlobalOptFlags() | | 
|  | CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing); | 
|  | if (getenv("LIBCLANG_BGPRIO_EDIT")) | 
|  | CIdxr->setCXGlobalOptFlags(CIdxr->getCXGlobalOptFlags() | | 
|  | CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForEditing); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CIdxr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_disposeIndex(CXIndex CIdx) { | 
|  | if (CIdx) | 
|  | delete static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_CXIndex_setGlobalOptions(CXIndex CIdx, unsigned options) { | 
|  | if (CIdx) | 
|  | static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx)->setCXGlobalOptFlags(options); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXIndex_getGlobalOptions(CXIndex CIdx) { | 
|  | if (CIdx) | 
|  | return static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx)->getCXGlobalOptFlags(); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_CXIndex_setInvocationEmissionPathOption(CXIndex CIdx, | 
|  | const char *Path) { | 
|  | if (CIdx) | 
|  | static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx)->setInvocationEmissionPath(Path ? Path : ""); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_toggleCrashRecovery(unsigned isEnabled) { | 
|  | if (isEnabled) | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContext::Enable(); | 
|  | else | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContext::Disable(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit clang_createTranslationUnit(CXIndex CIdx, | 
|  | const char *ast_filename) { | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU; | 
|  | enum CXErrorCode Result = | 
|  | clang_createTranslationUnit2(CIdx, ast_filename, &TU); | 
|  | (void)Result; | 
|  | assert((TU && Result == CXError_Success) || | 
|  | (!TU && Result != CXError_Success)); | 
|  | return TU; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum CXErrorCode clang_createTranslationUnit2(CXIndex CIdx, | 
|  | const char *ast_filename, | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit *out_TU) { | 
|  | if (out_TU) | 
|  | *out_TU = nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!CIdx || !ast_filename || !out_TU) | 
|  | return CXError_InvalidArguments; | 
|  |  | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { | 
|  | *Log << ast_filename; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CIndexer *CXXIdx = static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx); | 
|  | FileSystemOptions FileSystemOpts; | 
|  |  | 
|  | IntrusiveRefCntPtr<DiagnosticsEngine> Diags = | 
|  | CompilerInstance::createDiagnostics(new DiagnosticOptions()); | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<ASTUnit> AU = ASTUnit::LoadFromASTFile( | 
|  | ast_filename, CXXIdx->getPCHContainerOperations()->getRawReader(), | 
|  | ASTUnit::LoadEverything, Diags, | 
|  | FileSystemOpts, /*UseDebugInfo=*/false, | 
|  | CXXIdx->getOnlyLocalDecls(), None, | 
|  | /*CaptureDiagnostics=*/true, | 
|  | /*AllowPCHWithCompilerErrors=*/true, | 
|  | /*UserFilesAreVolatile=*/true); | 
|  | *out_TU = MakeCXTranslationUnit(CXXIdx, std::move(AU)); | 
|  | return *out_TU ? CXError_Success : CXError_Failure; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_defaultEditingTranslationUnitOptions() { | 
|  | return CXTranslationUnit_PrecompiledPreamble | | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit_CacheCompletionResults; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit | 
|  | clang_createTranslationUnitFromSourceFile(CXIndex CIdx, | 
|  | const char *source_filename, | 
|  | int num_command_line_args, | 
|  | const char * const *command_line_args, | 
|  | unsigned num_unsaved_files, | 
|  | struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files) { | 
|  | unsigned Options = CXTranslationUnit_DetailedPreprocessingRecord; | 
|  | return clang_parseTranslationUnit(CIdx, source_filename, | 
|  | command_line_args, num_command_line_args, | 
|  | unsaved_files, num_unsaved_files, | 
|  | Options); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CXErrorCode | 
|  | clang_parseTranslationUnit_Impl(CXIndex CIdx, const char *source_filename, | 
|  | const char *const *command_line_args, | 
|  | int num_command_line_args, | 
|  | ArrayRef<CXUnsavedFile> unsaved_files, | 
|  | unsigned options, CXTranslationUnit *out_TU) { | 
|  | // Set up the initial return values. | 
|  | if (out_TU) | 
|  | *out_TU = nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Check arguments. | 
|  | if (!CIdx || !out_TU) | 
|  | return CXError_InvalidArguments; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CIndexer *CXXIdx = static_cast<CIndexer *>(CIdx); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (CXXIdx->isOptEnabled(CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing)) | 
|  | setThreadBackgroundPriority(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool PrecompilePreamble = options & CXTranslationUnit_PrecompiledPreamble; | 
|  | bool CreatePreambleOnFirstParse = | 
|  | options & CXTranslationUnit_CreatePreambleOnFirstParse; | 
|  | // FIXME: Add a flag for modules. | 
|  | TranslationUnitKind TUKind | 
|  | = (options & (CXTranslationUnit_Incomplete | | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit_SingleFileParse))? TU_Prefix : TU_Complete; | 
|  | bool CacheCodeCompletionResults | 
|  | = options & CXTranslationUnit_CacheCompletionResults; | 
|  | bool IncludeBriefCommentsInCodeCompletion | 
|  | = options & CXTranslationUnit_IncludeBriefCommentsInCodeCompletion; | 
|  | bool SingleFileParse = options & CXTranslationUnit_SingleFileParse; | 
|  | bool ForSerialization = options & CXTranslationUnit_ForSerialization; | 
|  | SkipFunctionBodiesScope SkipFunctionBodies = SkipFunctionBodiesScope::None; | 
|  | if (options & CXTranslationUnit_SkipFunctionBodies) { | 
|  | SkipFunctionBodies = | 
|  | (options & CXTranslationUnit_LimitSkipFunctionBodiesToPreamble) | 
|  | ? SkipFunctionBodiesScope::Preamble | 
|  | : SkipFunctionBodiesScope::PreambleAndMainFile; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Configure the diagnostics. | 
|  | IntrusiveRefCntPtr<DiagnosticsEngine> | 
|  | Diags(CompilerInstance::createDiagnostics(new DiagnosticOptions)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (options & CXTranslationUnit_KeepGoing) | 
|  | Diags->setSuppressAfterFatalError(false); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Recover resources if we crash before exiting this function. | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContextCleanupRegistrar<DiagnosticsEngine, | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContextReleaseRefCleanup<DiagnosticsEngine> > | 
|  | DiagCleanup(Diags.get()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile>> RemappedFiles( | 
|  | new std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile>()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Recover resources if we crash before exiting this function. | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContextCleanupRegistrar< | 
|  | std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile> > RemappedCleanup(RemappedFiles.get()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (auto &UF : unsaved_files) { | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<llvm::MemoryBuffer> MB = | 
|  | llvm::MemoryBuffer::getMemBufferCopy(getContents(UF), UF.Filename); | 
|  | RemappedFiles->push_back(std::make_pair(UF.Filename, MB.release())); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<std::vector<const char *>> Args( | 
|  | new std::vector<const char *>()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Recover resources if we crash before exiting this method. | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContextCleanupRegistrar<std::vector<const char*> > | 
|  | ArgsCleanup(Args.get()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Since the Clang C library is primarily used by batch tools dealing with | 
|  | // (often very broken) source code, where spell-checking can have a | 
|  | // significant negative impact on performance (particularly when | 
|  | // precompiled headers are involved), we disable it by default. | 
|  | // Only do this if we haven't found a spell-checking-related argument. | 
|  | bool FoundSpellCheckingArgument = false; | 
|  | for (int I = 0; I != num_command_line_args; ++I) { | 
|  | if (strcmp(command_line_args[I], "-fno-spell-checking") == 0 || | 
|  | strcmp(command_line_args[I], "-fspell-checking") == 0) { | 
|  | FoundSpellCheckingArgument = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | Args->insert(Args->end(), command_line_args, | 
|  | command_line_args + num_command_line_args); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!FoundSpellCheckingArgument) | 
|  | Args->insert(Args->begin() + 1, "-fno-spell-checking"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // The 'source_filename' argument is optional.  If the caller does not | 
|  | // specify it then it is assumed that the source file is specified | 
|  | // in the actual argument list. | 
|  | // Put the source file after command_line_args otherwise if '-x' flag is | 
|  | // present it will be unused. | 
|  | if (source_filename) | 
|  | Args->push_back(source_filename); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Do we need the detailed preprocessing record? | 
|  | if (options & CXTranslationUnit_DetailedPreprocessingRecord) { | 
|  | Args->push_back("-Xclang"); | 
|  | Args->push_back("-detailed-preprocessing-record"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Suppress any editor placeholder diagnostics. | 
|  | Args->push_back("-fallow-editor-placeholders"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned NumErrors = Diags->getClient()->getNumErrors(); | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<ASTUnit> ErrUnit; | 
|  | // Unless the user specified that they want the preamble on the first parse | 
|  | // set it up to be created on the first reparse. This makes the first parse | 
|  | // faster, trading for a slower (first) reparse. | 
|  | unsigned PrecompilePreambleAfterNParses = | 
|  | !PrecompilePreamble ? 0 : 2 - CreatePreambleOnFirstParse; | 
|  |  | 
|  | LibclangInvocationReporter InvocationReporter( | 
|  | *CXXIdx, LibclangInvocationReporter::OperationKind::ParseOperation, | 
|  | options, llvm::makeArrayRef(*Args), /*InvocationArgs=*/None, | 
|  | unsaved_files); | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<ASTUnit> Unit(ASTUnit::LoadFromCommandLine( | 
|  | Args->data(), Args->data() + Args->size(), | 
|  | CXXIdx->getPCHContainerOperations(), Diags, | 
|  | CXXIdx->getClangResourcesPath(), CXXIdx->getOnlyLocalDecls(), | 
|  | /*CaptureDiagnostics=*/true, *RemappedFiles.get(), | 
|  | /*RemappedFilesKeepOriginalName=*/true, PrecompilePreambleAfterNParses, | 
|  | TUKind, CacheCodeCompletionResults, IncludeBriefCommentsInCodeCompletion, | 
|  | /*AllowPCHWithCompilerErrors=*/true, SkipFunctionBodies, SingleFileParse, | 
|  | /*UserFilesAreVolatile=*/true, ForSerialization, | 
|  | CXXIdx->getPCHContainerOperations()->getRawReader().getFormat(), | 
|  | &ErrUnit)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Early failures in LoadFromCommandLine may return with ErrUnit unset. | 
|  | if (!Unit && !ErrUnit) | 
|  | return CXError_ASTReadError; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (NumErrors != Diags->getClient()->getNumErrors()) { | 
|  | // Make sure to check that 'Unit' is non-NULL. | 
|  | if (CXXIdx->getDisplayDiagnostics()) | 
|  | printDiagsToStderr(Unit ? Unit.get() : ErrUnit.get()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isASTReadError(Unit ? Unit.get() : ErrUnit.get())) | 
|  | return CXError_ASTReadError; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *out_TU = MakeCXTranslationUnit(CXXIdx, std::move(Unit)); | 
|  | if (CXTranslationUnitImpl *TU = *out_TU) { | 
|  | TU->ParsingOptions = options; | 
|  | TU->Arguments.reserve(Args->size()); | 
|  | for (const char *Arg : *Args) | 
|  | TU->Arguments.push_back(Arg); | 
|  | return CXError_Success; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return CXError_Failure; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit | 
|  | clang_parseTranslationUnit(CXIndex CIdx, | 
|  | const char *source_filename, | 
|  | const char *const *command_line_args, | 
|  | int num_command_line_args, | 
|  | struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files, | 
|  | unsigned num_unsaved_files, | 
|  | unsigned options) { | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU; | 
|  | enum CXErrorCode Result = clang_parseTranslationUnit2( | 
|  | CIdx, source_filename, command_line_args, num_command_line_args, | 
|  | unsaved_files, num_unsaved_files, options, &TU); | 
|  | (void)Result; | 
|  | assert((TU && Result == CXError_Success) || | 
|  | (!TU && Result != CXError_Success)); | 
|  | return TU; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum CXErrorCode clang_parseTranslationUnit2( | 
|  | CXIndex CIdx, const char *source_filename, | 
|  | const char *const *command_line_args, int num_command_line_args, | 
|  | struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files, unsigned num_unsaved_files, | 
|  | unsigned options, CXTranslationUnit *out_TU) { | 
|  | SmallVector<const char *, 4> Args; | 
|  | Args.push_back("clang"); | 
|  | Args.append(command_line_args, command_line_args + num_command_line_args); | 
|  | return clang_parseTranslationUnit2FullArgv( | 
|  | CIdx, source_filename, Args.data(), Args.size(), unsaved_files, | 
|  | num_unsaved_files, options, out_TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum CXErrorCode clang_parseTranslationUnit2FullArgv( | 
|  | CXIndex CIdx, const char *source_filename, | 
|  | const char *const *command_line_args, int num_command_line_args, | 
|  | struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files, unsigned num_unsaved_files, | 
|  | unsigned options, CXTranslationUnit *out_TU) { | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { | 
|  | *Log << source_filename << ": "; | 
|  | for (int i = 0; i != num_command_line_args; ++i) | 
|  | *Log << command_line_args[i] << " "; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (num_unsaved_files && !unsaved_files) | 
|  | return CXError_InvalidArguments; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXErrorCode result = CXError_Failure; | 
|  | auto ParseTranslationUnitImpl = [=, &result] { | 
|  | result = clang_parseTranslationUnit_Impl( | 
|  | CIdx, source_filename, command_line_args, num_command_line_args, | 
|  | llvm::makeArrayRef(unsaved_files, num_unsaved_files), options, out_TU); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContext CRC; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!RunSafely(CRC, ParseTranslationUnitImpl)) { | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "libclang: crash detected during parsing: {\n"); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "  'source_filename' : '%s'\n", source_filename); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "  'command_line_args' : ["); | 
|  | for (int i = 0; i != num_command_line_args; ++i) { | 
|  | if (i) | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, ", "); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "'%s'", command_line_args[i]); | 
|  | } | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "],\n"); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "  'unsaved_files' : ["); | 
|  | for (unsigned i = 0; i != num_unsaved_files; ++i) { | 
|  | if (i) | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, ", "); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "('%s', '...', %ld)", unsaved_files[i].Filename, | 
|  | unsaved_files[i].Length); | 
|  | } | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "],\n"); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "  'options' : %d,\n", options); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "}\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXError_Crashed; | 
|  | } else if (getenv("LIBCLANG_RESOURCE_USAGE")) { | 
|  | if (CXTranslationUnit *TU = out_TU) | 
|  | PrintLibclangResourceUsage(*TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_Type_getObjCEncoding(CXType CT) { | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit tu = static_cast<CXTranslationUnit>(CT.data[1]); | 
|  | ASTContext &Ctx = getASTUnit(tu)->getASTContext(); | 
|  | std::string encoding; | 
|  | Ctx.getObjCEncodingForType(QualType::getFromOpaquePtr(CT.data[0]), | 
|  | encoding); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(encoding); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const IdentifierInfo *getMacroIdentifier(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition) { | 
|  | if (const MacroDefinitionRecord *MDR = getCursorMacroDefinition(C)) | 
|  | return MDR->getName(); | 
|  | } else if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) { | 
|  | MacroExpansionCursor ME = getCursorMacroExpansion(C); | 
|  | return ME.getName(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_isMacroFunctionLike(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | const IdentifierInfo *II = getMacroIdentifier(C); | 
|  | if (!II) { | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | ASTUnit *ASTU = getCursorASTUnit(C); | 
|  | Preprocessor &PP = ASTU->getPreprocessor(); | 
|  | if (const MacroInfo *MI = PP.getMacroInfo(II)) | 
|  | return MI->isFunctionLike(); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_isMacroBuiltin(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | const IdentifierInfo *II = getMacroIdentifier(C); | 
|  | if (!II) { | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | ASTUnit *ASTU = getCursorASTUnit(C); | 
|  | Preprocessor &PP = ASTU->getPreprocessor(); | 
|  | if (const MacroInfo *MI = PP.getMacroInfo(II)) | 
|  | return MI->isBuiltinMacro(); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_isFunctionInlined(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); | 
|  | if (!FD) { | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return FD->isInlined(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static StringLiteral* getCFSTR_value(CallExpr *callExpr) { | 
|  | if (callExpr->getNumArgs() != 1) { | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | StringLiteral *S = nullptr; | 
|  | auto *arg = callExpr->getArg(0); | 
|  | if (arg->getStmtClass() == Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass) { | 
|  | ImplicitCastExpr *I = static_cast<ImplicitCastExpr *>(arg); | 
|  | auto *subExpr = I->getSubExprAsWritten(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if(subExpr->getStmtClass() != Stmt::StringLiteralClass){ | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | S = static_cast<StringLiteral *>(I->getSubExprAsWritten()); | 
|  | } else if (arg->getStmtClass() == Stmt::StringLiteralClass) { | 
|  | S = static_cast<StringLiteral *>(callExpr->getArg(0)); | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return S; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct ExprEvalResult { | 
|  | CXEvalResultKind EvalType; | 
|  | union { | 
|  | unsigned long long unsignedVal; | 
|  | long long intVal; | 
|  | double floatVal; | 
|  | char *stringVal; | 
|  | } EvalData; | 
|  | bool IsUnsignedInt; | 
|  | ~ExprEvalResult() { | 
|  | if (EvalType != CXEval_UnExposed && EvalType != CXEval_Float && | 
|  | EvalType != CXEval_Int) { | 
|  | delete EvalData.stringVal; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_EvalResult_dispose(CXEvalResult E) { | 
|  | delete static_cast<ExprEvalResult *>(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXEvalResultKind clang_EvalResult_getKind(CXEvalResult E) { | 
|  | if (!E) { | 
|  | return CXEval_UnExposed; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return ((ExprEvalResult *)E)->EvalType; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_EvalResult_getAsInt(CXEvalResult E) { | 
|  | return clang_EvalResult_getAsLongLong(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | long long clang_EvalResult_getAsLongLong(CXEvalResult E) { | 
|  | if (!E) { | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | ExprEvalResult *Result = (ExprEvalResult*)E; | 
|  | if (Result->IsUnsignedInt) | 
|  | return Result->EvalData.unsignedVal; | 
|  | return Result->EvalData.intVal; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_EvalResult_isUnsignedInt(CXEvalResult E) { | 
|  | return ((ExprEvalResult *)E)->IsUnsignedInt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned long long clang_EvalResult_getAsUnsigned(CXEvalResult E) { | 
|  | if (!E) { | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ExprEvalResult *Result = (ExprEvalResult*)E; | 
|  | if (Result->IsUnsignedInt) | 
|  | return Result->EvalData.unsignedVal; | 
|  | return Result->EvalData.intVal; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | double clang_EvalResult_getAsDouble(CXEvalResult E) { | 
|  | if (!E) { | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return ((ExprEvalResult *)E)->EvalData.floatVal; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const char* clang_EvalResult_getAsStr(CXEvalResult E) { | 
|  | if (!E) { | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return ((ExprEvalResult *)E)->EvalData.stringVal; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const ExprEvalResult* evaluateExpr(Expr *expr, CXCursor C) { | 
|  | Expr::EvalResult ER; | 
|  | ASTContext &ctx = getCursorContext(C); | 
|  | if (!expr) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | expr = expr->IgnoreParens(); | 
|  | if (!expr->EvaluateAsRValue(ER, ctx)) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | QualType rettype; | 
|  | CallExpr *callExpr; | 
|  | auto result = llvm::make_unique<ExprEvalResult>(); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_UnExposed; | 
|  | result->IsUnsignedInt = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ER.Val.isInt()) { | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_Int; | 
|  |  | 
|  | auto& val = ER.Val.getInt(); | 
|  | if (val.isUnsigned()) { | 
|  | result->IsUnsignedInt = true; | 
|  | result->EvalData.unsignedVal = val.getZExtValue(); | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | result->EvalData.intVal = val.getExtValue(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return result.release(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ER.Val.isFloat()) { | 
|  | llvm::SmallVector<char, 100> Buffer; | 
|  | ER.Val.getFloat().toString(Buffer); | 
|  | std::string floatStr(Buffer.data(), Buffer.size()); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_Float; | 
|  | bool ignored; | 
|  | llvm::APFloat apFloat = ER.Val.getFloat(); | 
|  | apFloat.convert(llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble(), | 
|  | llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); | 
|  | result->EvalData.floatVal = apFloat.convertToDouble(); | 
|  | return result.release(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass) { | 
|  | const ImplicitCastExpr *I = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(expr); | 
|  | auto *subExpr = I->getSubExprAsWritten(); | 
|  | if (subExpr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::StringLiteralClass || | 
|  | subExpr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass) { | 
|  | const StringLiteral *StrE = nullptr; | 
|  | const ObjCStringLiteral *ObjCExpr; | 
|  | ObjCExpr = dyn_cast<ObjCStringLiteral>(subExpr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ObjCExpr) { | 
|  | StrE = ObjCExpr->getString(); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_ObjCStrLiteral; | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | StrE = cast<StringLiteral>(I->getSubExprAsWritten()); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_StrLiteral; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::string strRef(StrE->getString().str()); | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strRef.size() + 1]; | 
|  | strncpy((char *)result->EvalData.stringVal, strRef.c_str(), | 
|  | strRef.size()); | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal[strRef.size()] = '\0'; | 
|  | return result.release(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } else if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass || | 
|  | expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::StringLiteralClass) { | 
|  | const StringLiteral *StrE = nullptr; | 
|  | const ObjCStringLiteral *ObjCExpr; | 
|  | ObjCExpr = dyn_cast<ObjCStringLiteral>(expr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (ObjCExpr) { | 
|  | StrE = ObjCExpr->getString(); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_ObjCStrLiteral; | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | StrE = cast<StringLiteral>(expr); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_StrLiteral; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::string strRef(StrE->getString().str()); | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strRef.size() + 1]; | 
|  | strncpy((char *)result->EvalData.stringVal, strRef.c_str(), strRef.size()); | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal[strRef.size()] = '\0'; | 
|  | return result.release(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::CStyleCastExprClass) { | 
|  | CStyleCastExpr *CC = static_cast<CStyleCastExpr *>(expr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | rettype = CC->getType(); | 
|  | if (rettype.getAsString() == "CFStringRef" && | 
|  | CC->getSubExpr()->getStmtClass() == Stmt::CallExprClass) { | 
|  |  | 
|  | callExpr = static_cast<CallExpr *>(CC->getSubExpr()); | 
|  | StringLiteral *S = getCFSTR_value(callExpr); | 
|  | if (S) { | 
|  | std::string strLiteral(S->getString().str()); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_CFStr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strLiteral.size() + 1]; | 
|  | strncpy((char *)result->EvalData.stringVal, strLiteral.c_str(), | 
|  | strLiteral.size()); | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal[strLiteral.size()] = '\0'; | 
|  | return result.release(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | } else if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::CallExprClass) { | 
|  | callExpr = static_cast<CallExpr *>(expr); | 
|  | rettype = callExpr->getCallReturnType(ctx); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (rettype->isVectorType() || callExpr->getNumArgs() > 1) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (rettype->isIntegralType(ctx) || rettype->isRealFloatingType()) { | 
|  | if (callExpr->getNumArgs() == 1 && | 
|  | !callExpr->getArg(0)->getType()->isIntegralType(ctx)) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } else if (rettype.getAsString() == "CFStringRef") { | 
|  |  | 
|  | StringLiteral *S = getCFSTR_value(callExpr); | 
|  | if (S) { | 
|  | std::string strLiteral(S->getString().str()); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_CFStr; | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strLiteral.size() + 1]; | 
|  | strncpy((char *)result->EvalData.stringVal, strLiteral.c_str(), | 
|  | strLiteral.size()); | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal[strLiteral.size()] = '\0'; | 
|  | return result.release(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } else if (expr->getStmtClass() == Stmt::DeclRefExprClass) { | 
|  | DeclRefExpr *D = static_cast<DeclRefExpr *>(expr); | 
|  | ValueDecl *V = D->getDecl(); | 
|  | if (V->getKind() == Decl::Function) { | 
|  | std::string strName = V->getNameAsString(); | 
|  | result->EvalType = CXEval_Other; | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal = new char[strName.size() + 1]; | 
|  | strncpy(result->EvalData.stringVal, strName.c_str(), strName.size()); | 
|  | result->EvalData.stringVal[strName.size()] = '\0'; | 
|  | return result.release(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXEvalResult clang_Cursor_Evaluate(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (D) { | 
|  | const Expr *expr = nullptr; | 
|  | if (auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | expr = Var->getInit(); | 
|  | } else if (auto *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | expr = Field->getInClassInitializer(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (expr) | 
|  | return const_cast<CXEvalResult>(reinterpret_cast<const void *>( | 
|  | evaluateExpr(const_cast<Expr *>(expr), C))); | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const CompoundStmt *compoundStmt = dyn_cast_or_null<CompoundStmt>(getCursorStmt(C)); | 
|  | if (compoundStmt) { | 
|  | Expr *expr = nullptr; | 
|  | for (auto *bodyIterator : compoundStmt->body()) { | 
|  | if ((expr = dyn_cast<Expr>(bodyIterator))) { | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (expr) | 
|  | return const_cast<CXEvalResult>( | 
|  | reinterpret_cast<const void *>(evaluateExpr(expr, C))); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_hasAttrs(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D) { | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (D->hasAttrs()) { | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | unsigned clang_defaultSaveOptions(CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | return CXSaveTranslationUnit_None; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CXSaveError clang_saveTranslationUnit_Impl(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | const char *FileName, | 
|  | unsigned options) { | 
|  | CIndexer *CXXIdx = TU->CIdx; | 
|  | if (CXXIdx->isOptEnabled(CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForIndexing)) | 
|  | setThreadBackgroundPriority(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool hadError = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->Save(FileName); | 
|  | return hadError ? CXSaveError_Unknown : CXSaveError_None; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_saveTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit TU, const char *FileName, | 
|  | unsigned options) { | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { | 
|  | *Log << TU << ' ' << FileName; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return CXSaveError_InvalidTU; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit); | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit->hasSema()) | 
|  | return CXSaveError_InvalidTU; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSaveError result; | 
|  | auto SaveTranslationUnitImpl = [=, &result]() { | 
|  | result = clang_saveTranslationUnit_Impl(TU, FileName, options); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit->getDiagnostics().hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) { | 
|  | SaveTranslationUnitImpl(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (getenv("LIBCLANG_RESOURCE_USAGE")) | 
|  | PrintLibclangResourceUsage(TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // We have an AST that has invalid nodes due to compiler errors. | 
|  | // Use a crash recovery thread for protection. | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContext CRC; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!RunSafely(CRC, SaveTranslationUnitImpl)) { | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "libclang: crash detected during AST saving: {\n"); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "  'filename' : '%s'\n", FileName); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "  'options' : %d,\n", options); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "}\n"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXSaveError_Unknown; | 
|  |  | 
|  | } else if (getenv("LIBCLANG_RESOURCE_USAGE")) { | 
|  | PrintLibclangResourceUsage(TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_disposeTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit) { | 
|  | if (CTUnit) { | 
|  | // If the translation unit has been marked as unsafe to free, just discard | 
|  | // it. | 
|  | ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit); | 
|  | if (Unit && Unit->isUnsafeToFree()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | delete cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit); | 
|  | delete CTUnit->StringPool; | 
|  | delete static_cast<CXDiagnosticSetImpl *>(CTUnit->Diagnostics); | 
|  | disposeOverridenCXCursorsPool(CTUnit->OverridenCursorsPool); | 
|  | delete CTUnit->CommentToXML; | 
|  | delete CTUnit; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_suspendTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit) { | 
|  | if (CTUnit) { | 
|  | ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Unit && Unit->isUnsafeToFree()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | Unit->ResetForParse(); | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_defaultReparseOptions(CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | return CXReparse_None; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CXErrorCode | 
|  | clang_reparseTranslationUnit_Impl(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | ArrayRef<CXUnsavedFile> unsaved_files, | 
|  | unsigned options) { | 
|  | // Check arguments. | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return CXError_InvalidArguments; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Reset the associated diagnostics. | 
|  | delete static_cast<CXDiagnosticSetImpl*>(TU->Diagnostics); | 
|  | TU->Diagnostics = nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CIndexer *CXXIdx = TU->CIdx; | 
|  | if (CXXIdx->isOptEnabled(CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForEditing)) | 
|  | setThreadBackgroundPriority(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit); | 
|  |  | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile>> RemappedFiles( | 
|  | new std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile>()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Recover resources if we crash before exiting this function. | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContextCleanupRegistrar< | 
|  | std::vector<ASTUnit::RemappedFile> > RemappedCleanup(RemappedFiles.get()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (auto &UF : unsaved_files) { | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<llvm::MemoryBuffer> MB = | 
|  | llvm::MemoryBuffer::getMemBufferCopy(getContents(UF), UF.Filename); | 
|  | RemappedFiles->push_back(std::make_pair(UF.Filename, MB.release())); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit->Reparse(CXXIdx->getPCHContainerOperations(), | 
|  | *RemappedFiles.get())) | 
|  | return CXError_Success; | 
|  | if (isASTReadError(CXXUnit)) | 
|  | return CXError_ASTReadError; | 
|  | return CXError_Failure; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_reparseTranslationUnit(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | unsigned num_unsaved_files, | 
|  | struct CXUnsavedFile *unsaved_files, | 
|  | unsigned options) { | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { | 
|  | *Log << TU; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (num_unsaved_files && !unsaved_files) | 
|  | return CXError_InvalidArguments; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXErrorCode result; | 
|  | auto ReparseTranslationUnitImpl = [=, &result]() { | 
|  | result = clang_reparseTranslationUnit_Impl( | 
|  | TU, llvm::makeArrayRef(unsaved_files, num_unsaved_files), options); | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContext CRC; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!RunSafely(CRC, ReparseTranslationUnitImpl)) { | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "libclang: crash detected during reparsing\n"); | 
|  | cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->setUnsafeToFree(true); | 
|  | return CXError_Crashed; | 
|  | } else if (getenv("LIBCLANG_RESOURCE_USAGE")) | 
|  | PrintLibclangResourceUsage(TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_getTranslationUnitSpelling(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(CTUnit)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(CTUnit); | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(CXXUnit->getOriginalSourceFileName()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getTranslationUnitCursor(CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(CXXUnit->getASTContext().getTranslationUnitDecl(), TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTargetInfo clang_getTranslationUnitTargetInfo(CXTranslationUnit CTUnit) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(CTUnit)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(CTUnit); | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTargetInfoImpl* impl = new CXTargetInfoImpl(); | 
|  | impl->TranslationUnit = CTUnit; | 
|  | return impl; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_TargetInfo_getTriple(CXTargetInfo TargetInfo) { | 
|  | if (!TargetInfo) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit CTUnit = TargetInfo->TranslationUnit; | 
|  | assert(!isNotUsableTU(CTUnit) && | 
|  | "Unexpected unusable translation unit in TargetInfo"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit); | 
|  | std::string Triple = | 
|  | CXXUnit->getASTContext().getTargetInfo().getTriple().normalize(); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Triple); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_TargetInfo_getPointerWidth(CXTargetInfo TargetInfo) { | 
|  | if (!TargetInfo) | 
|  | return -1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit CTUnit = TargetInfo->TranslationUnit; | 
|  | assert(!isNotUsableTU(CTUnit) && | 
|  | "Unexpected unusable translation unit in TargetInfo"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(CTUnit); | 
|  | return CXXUnit->getASTContext().getTargetInfo().getMaxPointerWidth(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_TargetInfo_dispose(CXTargetInfo TargetInfo) { | 
|  | if (!TargetInfo) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | delete TargetInfo; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // CXFile Operations. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_getFileName(CXFile SFile) { | 
|  | if (!SFile) | 
|  | return cxstring::createNull(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(SFile); | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(FEnt->getName()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | time_t clang_getFileTime(CXFile SFile) { | 
|  | if (!SFile) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(SFile); | 
|  | return FEnt->getModificationTime(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXFile clang_getFile(CXTranslationUnit TU, const char *file_name) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | FileManager &FMgr = CXXUnit->getFileManager(); | 
|  | return const_cast<FileEntry *>(FMgr.getFile(file_name)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const char *clang_getFileContents(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXFile file, | 
|  | size_t *size) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const SourceManager &SM = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | FileID fid = SM.translateFile(static_cast<FileEntry *>(file)); | 
|  | bool Invalid = true; | 
|  | llvm::MemoryBuffer *buf = SM.getBuffer(fid, &Invalid); | 
|  | if (Invalid) { | 
|  | if (size) | 
|  | *size = 0; | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (size) | 
|  | *size = buf->getBufferSize(); | 
|  | return buf->getBufferStart(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | CXFile file) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!file) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file); | 
|  | return CXXUnit->getPreprocessor().getHeaderSearchInfo() | 
|  | .isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FEnt); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_getFileUniqueID(CXFile file, CXFileUniqueID *outID) { | 
|  | if (!file || !outID) | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file); | 
|  | const llvm::sys::fs::UniqueID &ID = FEnt->getUniqueID(); | 
|  | outID->data[0] = ID.getDevice(); | 
|  | outID->data[1] = ID.getFile(); | 
|  | outID->data[2] = FEnt->getModificationTime(); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_File_isEqual(CXFile file1, CXFile file2) { | 
|  | if (file1 == file2) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!file1 || !file2) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | FileEntry *FEnt1 = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file1); | 
|  | FileEntry *FEnt2 = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file2); | 
|  | return FEnt1->getUniqueID() == FEnt2->getUniqueID(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_File_tryGetRealPathName(CXFile SFile) { | 
|  | if (!SFile) | 
|  | return cxstring::createNull(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | FileEntry *FEnt = static_cast<FileEntry *>(SFile); | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(FEnt->tryGetRealPathName()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // CXCursor Operations. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | static const Decl *getDeclFromExpr(const Stmt *E) { | 
|  | if (const ImplicitCastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return getDeclFromExpr(CE->getSubExpr()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const DeclRefExpr *RefExpr = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return RefExpr->getDecl(); | 
|  | if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return ME->getMemberDecl(); | 
|  | if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *RE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return RE->getDecl(); | 
|  | if (const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E)) { | 
|  | if (PRE->isExplicitProperty()) | 
|  | return PRE->getExplicitProperty(); | 
|  | // It could be messaging both getter and setter as in: | 
|  | // ++myobj.myprop; | 
|  | // in which case prefer to associate the setter since it is less obvious | 
|  | // from inspecting the source that the setter is going to get called. | 
|  | if (PRE->isMessagingSetter()) | 
|  | return PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter(); | 
|  | return PRE->getImplicitPropertyGetter(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (const PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return getDeclFromExpr(POE->getSyntacticForm()); | 
|  | if (const OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) | 
|  | if (Expr *Src = OVE->getSourceExpr()) | 
|  | return getDeclFromExpr(Src); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return getDeclFromExpr(CE->getCallee()); | 
|  | if (const CXXConstructExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(E)) | 
|  | if (!CE->isElidable()) | 
|  | return CE->getConstructor(); | 
|  | if (const CXXInheritedCtorInitExpr *CE = | 
|  | dyn_cast<CXXInheritedCtorInitExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return CE->getConstructor(); | 
|  | if (const ObjCMessageExpr *OME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return OME->getMethodDecl(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const ObjCProtocolExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return PE->getProtocol(); | 
|  | if (const SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr *NTTP | 
|  | = dyn_cast<SubstNonTypeTemplateParmPackExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return NTTP->getParameterPack(); | 
|  | if (const SizeOfPackExpr *SizeOfPack = dyn_cast<SizeOfPackExpr>(E)) | 
|  | if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(SizeOfPack->getPack()) || | 
|  | isa<ParmVarDecl>(SizeOfPack->getPack())) | 
|  | return SizeOfPack->getPack(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static SourceLocation getLocationFromExpr(const Expr *E) { | 
|  | if (const ImplicitCastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return getLocationFromExpr(CE->getSubExpr()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const ObjCMessageExpr *Msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return /*FIXME:*/Msg->getLeftLoc(); | 
|  | if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return DRE->getLocation(); | 
|  | if (const MemberExpr *Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return Member->getMemberLoc(); | 
|  | if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return Ivar->getLocation(); | 
|  | if (const SizeOfPackExpr *SizeOfPack = dyn_cast<SizeOfPackExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return SizeOfPack->getPackLoc(); | 
|  | if (const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PropRef = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return PropRef->getLocation(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return E->getLocStart(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | extern "C" { | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_visitChildren(CXCursor parent, | 
|  | CXCursorVisitor visitor, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data) { | 
|  | CursorVisitor CursorVis(getCursorTU(parent), visitor, client_data, | 
|  | /*VisitPreprocessorLast=*/false); | 
|  | return CursorVis.VisitChildren(parent); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifndef __has_feature | 
|  | #define __has_feature(x) 0 | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | #if __has_feature(blocks) | 
|  | typedef enum CXChildVisitResult | 
|  | (^CXCursorVisitorBlock)(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum CXChildVisitResult visitWithBlock(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data) { | 
|  | CXCursorVisitorBlock block = (CXCursorVisitorBlock)client_data; | 
|  | return block(cursor, parent); | 
|  | } | 
|  | #else | 
|  | // If we are compiled with a compiler that doesn't have native blocks support, | 
|  | // define and call the block manually, so the | 
|  | typedef struct _CXChildVisitResult | 
|  | { | 
|  | void *isa; | 
|  | int flags; | 
|  | int reserved; | 
|  | enum CXChildVisitResult(*invoke)(struct _CXChildVisitResult*, CXCursor, | 
|  | CXCursor); | 
|  | } *CXCursorVisitorBlock; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum CXChildVisitResult visitWithBlock(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data) { | 
|  | CXCursorVisitorBlock block = (CXCursorVisitorBlock)client_data; | 
|  | return block->invoke(block, cursor, parent); | 
|  | } | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_visitChildrenWithBlock(CXCursor parent, | 
|  | CXCursorVisitorBlock block) { | 
|  | return clang_visitChildren(parent, visitWithBlock, block); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CXString getDeclSpelling(const Decl *D) { | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D); | 
|  | if (!ND) { | 
|  | if (const ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropImpl = | 
|  | dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyImplDecl>(D)) | 
|  | if (ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = PropImpl->getPropertyDecl()) | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Property->getIdentifier()->getName()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const ImportDecl *ImportD = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) | 
|  | if (Module *Mod = ImportD->getImportedModule()) | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Mod->getFullModuleName()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(ND)) | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(OMD->getSelector().getAsString()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CIMP = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ND)) | 
|  | // No, this isn't the same as the code below. getIdentifier() is non-virtual | 
|  | // and returns different names. NamedDecl returns the class name and | 
|  | // ObjCCategoryImplDecl returns the category name. | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(CIMP->getIdentifier()->getNameStart()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isa<UsingDirectiveDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SmallString<1024> S; | 
|  | llvm::raw_svector_ostream os(S); | 
|  | ND->printName(os); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(os.str()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_getCursorSpelling(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isTranslationUnit(C.kind)) | 
|  | return clang_getTranslationUnitSpelling(getCursorTU(C)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isReference(C.kind)) { | 
|  | switch (C.kind) { | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef: { | 
|  | const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Super = getCursorObjCSuperClassRef(C).first; | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(Super->getIdentifier()->getNameStart()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef: { | 
|  | const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = getCursorObjCClassRef(C).first; | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(Class->getIdentifier()->getNameStart()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef: { | 
|  | const ObjCProtocolDecl *OID = getCursorObjCProtocolRef(C).first; | 
|  | assert(OID && "getCursorSpelling(): Missing protocol decl"); | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(OID->getIdentifier()->getNameStart()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier: { | 
|  | const CXXBaseSpecifier *B = getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(C); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(B->getType().getAsString()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | case CXCursor_TypeRef: { | 
|  | const TypeDecl *Type = getCursorTypeRef(C).first; | 
|  | assert(Type && "Missing type decl"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(getCursorContext(C).getTypeDeclType(Type). | 
|  | getAsString()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | case CXCursor_TemplateRef: { | 
|  | const TemplateDecl *Template = getCursorTemplateRef(C).first; | 
|  | assert(Template && "Missing template decl"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Template->getNameAsString()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_NamespaceRef: { | 
|  | const NamedDecl *NS = getCursorNamespaceRef(C).first; | 
|  | assert(NS && "Missing namespace decl"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(NS->getNameAsString()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_MemberRef: { | 
|  | const FieldDecl *Field = getCursorMemberRef(C).first; | 
|  | assert(Field && "Missing member decl"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Field->getNameAsString()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_LabelRef: { | 
|  | const LabelStmt *Label = getCursorLabelRef(C).first; | 
|  | assert(Label && "Missing label"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(Label->getName()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef: { | 
|  | OverloadedDeclRefStorage Storage = getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(C).first; | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = Storage.dyn_cast<const Decl *>()) { | 
|  | if (const NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(ND->getNameAsString()); | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (const OverloadExpr *E = Storage.dyn_cast<const OverloadExpr *>()) | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(E->getName().getAsString()); | 
|  | OverloadedTemplateStorage *Ovl | 
|  | = Storage.get<OverloadedTemplateStorage*>(); | 
|  | if (Ovl->size() == 0) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup((*Ovl->begin())->getNameAsString()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_VariableRef: { | 
|  | const VarDecl *Var = getCursorVariableRef(C).first; | 
|  | assert(Var && "Missing variable decl"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Var->getNameAsString()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("<not implemented>"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(C); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCStringLiteral || | 
|  | C.kind == CXCursor_StringLiteral) { | 
|  | const StringLiteral *SLit; | 
|  | if (const ObjCStringLiteral *OSL = dyn_cast<ObjCStringLiteral>(E)) { | 
|  | SLit = OSL->getString(); | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | SLit = cast<StringLiteral>(E); | 
|  | } | 
|  | SmallString<256> Buf; | 
|  | llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Buf); | 
|  | SLit->outputString(OS); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(OS.str()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(getCursorExpr(C)); | 
|  | if (D) | 
|  | return getDeclSpelling(D); | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isStatement(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Stmt *S = getCursorStmt(C); | 
|  | if (const LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast_or_null<LabelStmt>(S)) | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(Label->getName()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(getCursorMacroExpansion(C).getName() | 
|  | ->getNameStart()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition) | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(getCursorMacroDefinition(C)->getName() | 
|  | ->getNameStart()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_InclusionDirective) | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(getCursorInclusionDirective(C)->getFileName()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return getDeclSpelling(getCursorDecl(C)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_AnnotateAttr) { | 
|  | const AnnotateAttr *AA = cast<AnnotateAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C)); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(AA->getAnnotation()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_AsmLabelAttr) { | 
|  | const AsmLabelAttr *AA = cast<AsmLabelAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C)); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(AA->getLabel()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_PackedAttr) { | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("packed"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_VisibilityAttr) { | 
|  | const VisibilityAttr *AA = cast<VisibilityAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C)); | 
|  | switch (AA->getVisibility()) { | 
|  | case VisibilityAttr::VisibilityType::Default: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("default"); | 
|  | case VisibilityAttr::VisibilityType::Hidden: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("hidden"); | 
|  | case VisibilityAttr::VisibilityType::Protected: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("protected"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("unknown visibility type"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceRange clang_Cursor_getSpellingNameRange(CXCursor C, | 
|  | unsigned pieceIndex, | 
|  | unsigned options) { | 
|  | if (clang_Cursor_isNull(C)) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTContext &Ctx = getCursorContext(C); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isStatement(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Stmt *S = getCursorStmt(C); | 
|  | if (const LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast_or_null<LabelStmt>(S)) { | 
|  | if (pieceIndex > 0) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, Label->getIdentLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCMessageExpr) { | 
|  | if (const ObjCMessageExpr * | 
|  | ME = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMessageExpr>(getCursorExpr(C))) { | 
|  | if (pieceIndex >= ME->getNumSelectorLocs()) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, ME->getSelectorLoc(pieceIndex)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl || | 
|  | C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl) { | 
|  | if (const ObjCMethodDecl * | 
|  | MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) { | 
|  | if (pieceIndex >= MD->getNumSelectorLocs()) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, MD->getSelectorLoc(pieceIndex)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCCategoryDecl || | 
|  | C.kind == CXCursor_ObjCCategoryImplDecl) { | 
|  | if (pieceIndex > 0) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | if (const ObjCCategoryDecl * | 
|  | CD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCCategoryDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, CD->getCategoryNameLoc()); | 
|  | if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl * | 
|  | CID = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, CID->getCategoryNameLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_ModuleImportDecl) { | 
|  | if (pieceIndex > 0) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | if (const ImportDecl *ImportD = | 
|  | dyn_cast_or_null<ImportDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) { | 
|  | ArrayRef<SourceLocation> Locs = ImportD->getIdentifierLocs(); | 
|  | if (!Locs.empty()) | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, | 
|  | SourceRange(Locs.front(), Locs.back())); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_CXXMethod || C.kind == CXCursor_Destructor || | 
|  | C.kind == CXCursor_ConversionFunction || | 
|  | C.kind == CXCursor_FunctionDecl) { | 
|  | if (pieceIndex > 0) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | if (const FunctionDecl *FD = | 
|  | dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) { | 
|  | DeclarationNameInfo FunctionName = FD->getNameInfo(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, FunctionName.getSourceRange()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: A CXCursor_InclusionDirective should give the location of the | 
|  | // filename, but we don't keep track of this. | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: A CXCursor_AnnotateAttr should give the location of the annotation | 
|  | // but we don't keep track of this. | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: A CXCursor_AsmLabelAttr should give the location of the label | 
|  | // but we don't keep track of this. | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Default handling, give the location of the cursor. | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (pieceIndex > 0) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceLocation CXLoc = clang_getCursorLocation(C); | 
|  | SourceLocation Loc = cxloc::translateSourceLocation(CXLoc); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, Loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_Cursor_getMangling(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind) || !clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Mangling only works for functions and variables. | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D || !(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D))) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTContext &Ctx = D->getASTContext(); | 
|  | index::CodegenNameGenerator CGNameGen(Ctx); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(CGNameGen.getName(D)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXStringSet *clang_Cursor_getCXXManglings(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind) || !clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!(isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D) || isa<CXXMethodDecl>(D))) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTContext &Ctx = D->getASTContext(); | 
|  | index::CodegenNameGenerator CGNameGen(Ctx); | 
|  | std::vector<std::string> Manglings = CGNameGen.getAllManglings(D); | 
|  | return cxstring::createSet(Manglings); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXStringSet *clang_Cursor_getObjCManglings(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind) || !clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!(isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCImplementationDecl>(D))) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTContext &Ctx = D->getASTContext(); | 
|  | index::CodegenNameGenerator CGNameGen(Ctx); | 
|  | std::vector<std::string> Manglings = CGNameGen.getAllManglings(D); | 
|  | return cxstring::createSet(Manglings); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXPrintingPolicy clang_getCursorPrintingPolicy(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_Cursor_isNull(C)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | return new PrintingPolicy(getCursorContext(C).getPrintingPolicy()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_PrintingPolicy_dispose(CXPrintingPolicy Policy) { | 
|  | if (Policy) | 
|  | delete static_cast<PrintingPolicy *>(Policy); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned | 
|  | clang_PrintingPolicy_getProperty(CXPrintingPolicy Policy, | 
|  | enum CXPrintingPolicyProperty Property) { | 
|  | if (!Policy) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | PrintingPolicy *P = static_cast<PrintingPolicy *>(Policy); | 
|  | switch (Property) { | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Indentation: | 
|  | return P->Indentation; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressSpecifiers: | 
|  | return P->SuppressSpecifiers; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressTagKeyword: | 
|  | return P->SuppressTagKeyword; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_IncludeTagDefinition: | 
|  | return P->IncludeTagDefinition; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressScope: | 
|  | return P->SuppressScope; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressUnwrittenScope: | 
|  | return P->SuppressUnwrittenScope; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressInitializers: | 
|  | return P->SuppressInitializers; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_ConstantArraySizeAsWritten: | 
|  | return P->ConstantArraySizeAsWritten; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_AnonymousTagLocations: | 
|  | return P->AnonymousTagLocations; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressStrongLifetime: | 
|  | return P->SuppressStrongLifetime; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressLifetimeQualifiers: | 
|  | return P->SuppressLifetimeQualifiers; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressTemplateArgsInCXXConstructors: | 
|  | return P->SuppressTemplateArgsInCXXConstructors; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Bool: | 
|  | return P->Bool; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Restrict: | 
|  | return P->Restrict; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Alignof: | 
|  | return P->Alignof; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_UnderscoreAlignof: | 
|  | return P->UnderscoreAlignof; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_UseVoidForZeroParams: | 
|  | return P->UseVoidForZeroParams; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_TerseOutput: | 
|  | return P->TerseOutput; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_PolishForDeclaration: | 
|  | return P->PolishForDeclaration; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Half: | 
|  | return P->Half; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_MSWChar: | 
|  | return P->MSWChar; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_IncludeNewlines: | 
|  | return P->IncludeNewlines; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_MSVCFormatting: | 
|  | return P->MSVCFormatting; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_ConstantsAsWritten: | 
|  | return P->ConstantsAsWritten; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressImplicitBase: | 
|  | return P->SuppressImplicitBase; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_FullyQualifiedName: | 
|  | return P->FullyQualifiedName; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | assert(false && "Invalid CXPrintingPolicyProperty"); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_PrintingPolicy_setProperty(CXPrintingPolicy Policy, | 
|  | enum CXPrintingPolicyProperty Property, | 
|  | unsigned Value) { | 
|  | if (!Policy) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | PrintingPolicy *P = static_cast<PrintingPolicy *>(Policy); | 
|  | switch (Property) { | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Indentation: | 
|  | P->Indentation = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressSpecifiers: | 
|  | P->SuppressSpecifiers = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressTagKeyword: | 
|  | P->SuppressTagKeyword = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_IncludeTagDefinition: | 
|  | P->IncludeTagDefinition = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressScope: | 
|  | P->SuppressScope = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressUnwrittenScope: | 
|  | P->SuppressUnwrittenScope = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressInitializers: | 
|  | P->SuppressInitializers = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_ConstantArraySizeAsWritten: | 
|  | P->ConstantArraySizeAsWritten = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_AnonymousTagLocations: | 
|  | P->AnonymousTagLocations = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressStrongLifetime: | 
|  | P->SuppressStrongLifetime = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressLifetimeQualifiers: | 
|  | P->SuppressLifetimeQualifiers = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressTemplateArgsInCXXConstructors: | 
|  | P->SuppressTemplateArgsInCXXConstructors = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Bool: | 
|  | P->Bool = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Restrict: | 
|  | P->Restrict = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Alignof: | 
|  | P->Alignof = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_UnderscoreAlignof: | 
|  | P->UnderscoreAlignof = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_UseVoidForZeroParams: | 
|  | P->UseVoidForZeroParams = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_TerseOutput: | 
|  | P->TerseOutput = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_PolishForDeclaration: | 
|  | P->PolishForDeclaration = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_Half: | 
|  | P->Half = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_MSWChar: | 
|  | P->MSWChar = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_IncludeNewlines: | 
|  | P->IncludeNewlines = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_MSVCFormatting: | 
|  | P->MSVCFormatting = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_ConstantsAsWritten: | 
|  | P->ConstantsAsWritten = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_SuppressImplicitBase: | 
|  | P->SuppressImplicitBase = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | case CXPrintingPolicy_FullyQualifiedName: | 
|  | P->FullyQualifiedName = Value; | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | assert(false && "Invalid CXPrintingPolicyProperty"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_getCursorPrettyPrinted(CXCursor C, CXPrintingPolicy cxPolicy) { | 
|  | if (clang_Cursor_isNull(C)) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SmallString<128> Str; | 
|  | llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); | 
|  | PrintingPolicy *UserPolicy = static_cast<PrintingPolicy *>(cxPolicy); | 
|  | D->print(OS, UserPolicy ? *UserPolicy | 
|  | : getCursorContext(C).getPrintingPolicy()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(OS.str()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_getCursorDisplayName(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return clang_getCursorSpelling(C); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | PrintingPolicy Policy = getCursorContext(C).getPrintingPolicy(); | 
|  | if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) | 
|  | D = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | SmallString<64> Str; | 
|  | llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); | 
|  | OS << *Function; | 
|  | if (Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) | 
|  | OS << "<>"; | 
|  | OS << "("; | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = Function->getNumParams(); I != N; ++I) { | 
|  | if (I) | 
|  | OS << ", "; | 
|  | OS << Function->getParamDecl(I)->getType().getAsString(Policy); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Function->isVariadic()) { | 
|  | if (Function->getNumParams()) | 
|  | OS << ", "; | 
|  | OS << "..."; | 
|  | } | 
|  | OS << ")"; | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(OS.str()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const ClassTemplateDecl *ClassTemplate = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | SmallString<64> Str; | 
|  | llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); | 
|  | OS << *ClassTemplate; | 
|  | OS << "<"; | 
|  | TemplateParameterList *Params = ClassTemplate->getTemplateParameters(); | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0, N = Params->size(); I != N; ++I) { | 
|  | if (I) | 
|  | OS << ", "; | 
|  |  | 
|  | NamedDecl *Param = Params->getParam(I); | 
|  | if (Param->getIdentifier()) { | 
|  | OS << Param->getIdentifier()->getName(); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // There is no parameter name, which makes this tricky. Try to come up | 
|  | // with something useful that isn't too long. | 
|  | if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param)) | 
|  | OS << (TTP->wasDeclaredWithTypename()? "typename" : "class"); | 
|  | else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP | 
|  | = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param)) | 
|  | OS << NTTP->getType().getAsString(Policy); | 
|  | else | 
|  | OS << "template<...> class"; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | OS << ">"; | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(OS.str()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *ClassSpec | 
|  | = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | // If the type was explicitly written, use that. | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = ClassSpec->getTypeAsWritten()) | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(TSInfo->getType().getAsString(Policy)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SmallString<128> Str; | 
|  | llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); | 
|  | OS << *ClassSpec; | 
|  | printTemplateArgumentList(OS, ClassSpec->getTemplateArgs().asArray(), | 
|  | Policy); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(OS.str()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getCursorSpelling(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_getCursorKindSpelling(enum CXCursorKind Kind) { | 
|  | switch (Kind) { | 
|  | case CXCursor_FunctionDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("FunctionDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_TypedefDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("TypedefDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_EnumDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("EnumDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_EnumConstantDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("EnumConstantDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_StructDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("StructDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnionDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UnionDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ClassDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ClassDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_FieldDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("FieldDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_VarDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("VarDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ParmDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ParmDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCInterfaceDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCInterfaceDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCCategoryDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCCategoryDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCProtocolDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCPropertyDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCIvarDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCIvarDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCInstanceMethodDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCClassMethodDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCImplementationDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCImplementationDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCCategoryImplDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCCategoryImplDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXMethod: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXMethod"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnexposedDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UnexposedDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCSuperClassRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCProtocolRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCClassRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_TypeRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("TypeRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_TemplateRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("TemplateRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_NamespaceRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("NamespaceRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_MemberRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("MemberRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_LabelRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("LabelRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OverloadedDeclRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_VariableRef: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("VariableRef"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_IntegerLiteral: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("IntegerLiteral"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_FixedPointLiteral: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("FixedPointLiteral"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_FloatingLiteral: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("FloatingLiteral"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ImaginaryLiteral: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ImaginaryLiteral"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_StringLiteral: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("StringLiteral"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CharacterLiteral: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CharacterLiteral"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ParenExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ParenExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnaryOperator: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UnaryOperator"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ArraySubscriptExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ArraySubscriptExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPArraySectionExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPArraySectionExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_BinaryOperator: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("BinaryOperator"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CompoundAssignOperator: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CompoundAssignOperator"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ConditionalOperator: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ConditionalOperator"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CStyleCastExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CStyleCastExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CompoundLiteralExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CompoundLiteralExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_InitListExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("InitListExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_AddrLabelExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("AddrLabelExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_StmtExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("StmtExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_GenericSelectionExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("GenericSelectionExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_GNUNullExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("GNUNullExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXStaticCastExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXStaticCastExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXDynamicCastExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXDynamicCastExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXReinterpretCastExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXReinterpretCastExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXConstCastExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXConstCastExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXFunctionalCastExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXFunctionalCastExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXTypeidExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXTypeidExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXBoolLiteralExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXBoolLiteralExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXNullPtrLiteralExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXNullPtrLiteralExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXThisExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXThisExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXThrowExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXThrowExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXNewExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXNewExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXDeleteExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXDeleteExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnaryExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UnaryExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCStringLiteral: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCStringLiteral"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCBoolLiteralExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCBoolLiteralExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCSelfExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCSelfExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCEncodeExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCEncodeExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCSelectorExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCSelectorExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCProtocolExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCBridgedCastExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCBridgedCastExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_BlockExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("BlockExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_PackExpansionExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("PackExpansionExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_SizeOfPackExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("SizeOfPackExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_LambdaExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("LambdaExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnexposedExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UnexposedExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_DeclRefExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("DeclRefExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_MemberRefExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("MemberRefExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CallExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CallExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCMessageExpr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCMessageExpr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnexposedStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UnexposedStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_DeclStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("DeclStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_LabelStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("LabelStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CompoundStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CompoundStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CaseStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CaseStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_DefaultStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("DefaultStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_IfStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("IfStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_SwitchStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("SwitchStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_WhileStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("WhileStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_DoStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("DoStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ForStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ForStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_GotoStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("GotoStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_IndirectGotoStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("IndirectGotoStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ContinueStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ContinueStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_BreakStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("BreakStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ReturnStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ReturnStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_GCCAsmStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("GCCAsmStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_MSAsmStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("MSAsmStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCAtTryStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtTryStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCAtCatchStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtCatchStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCAtFinallyStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtFinallyStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCAtThrowStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtThrowStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCAtSynchronizedStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAtSynchronizedStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCAutoreleasePoolStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCAutoreleasePoolStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCForCollectionStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCForCollectionStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXCatchStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXCatchStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXTryStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXTryStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXForRangeStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXForRangeStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_SEHTryStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("SEHTryStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_SEHExceptStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("SEHExceptStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_SEHFinallyStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("SEHFinallyStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_SEHLeaveStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("SEHLeaveStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_NullStmt: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("NullStmt"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_InvalidFile: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("InvalidFile"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_InvalidCode: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("InvalidCode"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_NoDeclFound: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("NoDeclFound"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_NotImplemented: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("NotImplemented"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_TranslationUnit: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("TranslationUnit"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnexposedAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UnexposedAttr"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_IBActionAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(ibaction)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_IBOutletAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(iboutlet)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_IBOutletCollectionAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(iboutletcollection)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXFinalAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(final)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXOverrideAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(override)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_AnnotateAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(annotate)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_AsmLabelAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("asm label"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_PackedAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(packed)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_PureAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(pure)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ConstAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(const)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_NoDuplicateAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(noduplicate)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CUDAConstantAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(constant)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CUDADeviceAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(device)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CUDAGlobalAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(global)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CUDAHostAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(host)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CUDASharedAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(shared)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_VisibilityAttr: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(visibility)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_DLLExport: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(dllexport)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_DLLImport: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("attribute(dllimport)"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_PreprocessingDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("preprocessing directive"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_MacroDefinition: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("macro definition"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_MacroExpansion: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("macro expansion"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_InclusionDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("inclusion directive"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_Namespace: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("Namespace"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_LinkageSpec: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("LinkageSpec"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("C++ base class specifier"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_Constructor: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXConstructor"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_Destructor: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXDestructor"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ConversionFunction: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXConversion"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_TemplateTypeParameter: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("TemplateTypeParameter"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_NonTypeTemplateParameter: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("NonTypeTemplateParameter"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_TemplateTemplateParameter: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("TemplateTemplateParameter"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_FunctionTemplate: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("FunctionTemplate"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ClassTemplate: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ClassTemplate"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_NamespaceAlias: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("NamespaceAlias"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UsingDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UsingDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_UsingDeclaration: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("UsingDeclaration"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_TypeAliasDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("TypeAliasDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCSynthesizeDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCSynthesizeDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCDynamicDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ObjCDynamicDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXAccessSpecifier: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("CXXAccessSpecifier"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_ModuleImportDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("ModuleImport"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPParallelDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPForDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPForDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPForSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPForSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPSectionsDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPSectionsDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPSectionDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPSectionDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPSingleDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPSingleDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPMasterDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPMasterDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPCriticalDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPCriticalDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPParallelForDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelForDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPParallelForSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelForSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPParallelSectionsDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPParallelSectionsDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTaskDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTaskyieldDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskyieldDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPBarrierDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPBarrierDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTaskwaitDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskwaitDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTaskgroupDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskgroupDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPFlushDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPFlushDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPOrderedDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPOrderedDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPAtomicDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPAtomicDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetDataDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetDataDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetEnterDataDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetEnterDataDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetExitDataDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetExitDataDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetParallelDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetParallelDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetParallelForDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetParallelForDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetUpdateDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetUpdateDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPCancellationPointDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPCancellationPointDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPCancelDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPCancelDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTaskLoopDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskLoopDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTaskLoopSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTaskLoopSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPDistributeDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPDistributeDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPDistributeParallelForDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPDistributeParallelForDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPDistributeParallelForSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPDistributeSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPDistributeSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetParallelForSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDistributeDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDistributeDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDistributeSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetTeamsDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetTeamsDistributeDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef( | 
|  | "OMPTargetTeamsDistributeParallelForSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OMPTargetTeamsDistributeSimdDirective"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_OverloadCandidate: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("OverloadCandidate"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_TypeAliasTemplateDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("TypeAliasTemplateDecl"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_StaticAssert: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("StaticAssert"); | 
|  | case CXCursor_FriendDecl: | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef("FriendDecl"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Unhandled CXCursorKind"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct GetCursorData { | 
|  | SourceLocation TokenBeginLoc; | 
|  | bool PointsAtMacroArgExpansion; | 
|  | bool VisitedObjCPropertyImplDecl; | 
|  | SourceLocation VisitedDeclaratorDeclStartLoc; | 
|  | CXCursor &BestCursor; | 
|  |  | 
|  | GetCursorData(SourceManager &SM, | 
|  | SourceLocation tokenBegin, CXCursor &outputCursor) | 
|  | : TokenBeginLoc(tokenBegin), BestCursor(outputCursor) { | 
|  | PointsAtMacroArgExpansion = SM.isMacroArgExpansion(tokenBegin); | 
|  | VisitedObjCPropertyImplDecl = false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum CXChildVisitResult GetCursorVisitor(CXCursor cursor, | 
|  | CXCursor parent, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data) { | 
|  | GetCursorData *Data = static_cast<GetCursorData *>(client_data); | 
|  | CXCursor *BestCursor = &Data->BestCursor; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If we point inside a macro argument we should provide info of what the | 
|  | // token is so use the actual cursor, don't replace it with a macro expansion | 
|  | // cursor. | 
|  | if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion && Data->PointsAtMacroArgExpansion) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Recurse; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | // Avoid having the implicit methods override the property decls. | 
|  | if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) { | 
|  | if (MD->isImplicit()) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | } else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) { | 
|  | // Check that when we have multiple @class references in the same line, | 
|  | // that later ones do not override the previous ones. | 
|  | // If we have: | 
|  | // @class Foo, Bar; | 
|  | // source ranges for both start at '@', so 'Bar' will end up overriding | 
|  | // 'Foo' even though the cursor location was at 'Foo'. | 
|  | if (BestCursor->kind == CXCursor_ObjCInterfaceDecl || | 
|  | BestCursor->kind == CXCursor_ObjCClassRef) | 
|  | if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevID | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(getCursorDecl(*BestCursor))){ | 
|  | if (PrevID != ID && | 
|  | !PrevID->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && | 
|  | !ID->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | } else if (const DeclaratorDecl *DD | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<DeclaratorDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) { | 
|  | SourceLocation StartLoc = DD->getSourceRange().getBegin(); | 
|  | // Check that when we have multiple declarators in the same line, | 
|  | // that later ones do not override the previous ones. | 
|  | // If we have: | 
|  | // int Foo, Bar; | 
|  | // source ranges for both start at 'int', so 'Bar' will end up overriding | 
|  | // 'Foo' even though the cursor location was at 'Foo'. | 
|  | if (Data->VisitedDeclaratorDeclStartLoc == StartLoc) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Break; | 
|  | Data->VisitedDeclaratorDeclStartLoc = StartLoc; | 
|  |  | 
|  | } else if (const ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropImp | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCPropertyImplDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) { | 
|  | (void)PropImp; | 
|  | // Check that when we have multiple @synthesize in the same line, | 
|  | // that later ones do not override the previous ones. | 
|  | // If we have: | 
|  | // @synthesize Foo, Bar; | 
|  | // source ranges for both start at '@', so 'Bar' will end up overriding | 
|  | // 'Foo' even though the cursor location was at 'Foo'. | 
|  | if (Data->VisitedObjCPropertyImplDecl) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Break; | 
|  | Data->VisitedObjCPropertyImplDecl = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(cursor.kind) && | 
|  | clang_isDeclaration(BestCursor->kind)) { | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(*BestCursor)) { | 
|  | // Avoid having the cursor of an expression replace the declaration cursor | 
|  | // when the expression source range overlaps the declaration range. | 
|  | // This can happen for C++ constructor expressions whose range generally | 
|  | // include the variable declaration, e.g.: | 
|  | //  MyCXXClass foo; // Make sure pointing at 'foo' returns a VarDecl cursor. | 
|  | if (D->getLocation().isValid() && Data->TokenBeginLoc.isValid() && | 
|  | D->getLocation() == Data->TokenBeginLoc) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If our current best cursor is the construction of a temporary object, | 
|  | // don't replace that cursor with a type reference, because we want | 
|  | // clang_getCursor() to point at the constructor. | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(BestCursor->kind) && | 
|  | isa<CXXTemporaryObjectExpr>(getCursorExpr(*BestCursor)) && | 
|  | cursor.kind == CXCursor_TypeRef) { | 
|  | // Keep the cursor pointing at CXXTemporaryObjectExpr but also mark it | 
|  | // as having the actual point on the type reference. | 
|  | *BestCursor = getTypeRefedCallExprCursor(*BestCursor); | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Recurse; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If we already have an Objective-C superclass reference, don't | 
|  | // update it further. | 
|  | if (BestCursor->kind == CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *BestCursor = cursor; | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Recurse; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getCursor(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXSourceLocation Loc) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation SLoc = cxloc::translateSourceLocation(Loc); | 
|  | CXCursor Result = cxcursor::getCursor(TU, SLoc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { | 
|  | CXFile SearchFile; | 
|  | unsigned SearchLine, SearchColumn; | 
|  | CXFile ResultFile; | 
|  | unsigned ResultLine, ResultColumn; | 
|  | CXString SearchFileName, ResultFileName, KindSpelling, USR; | 
|  | const char *IsDef = clang_isCursorDefinition(Result)? " (Definition)" : ""; | 
|  | CXSourceLocation ResultLoc = clang_getCursorLocation(Result); | 
|  |  | 
|  | clang_getFileLocation(Loc, &SearchFile, &SearchLine, &SearchColumn, | 
|  | nullptr); | 
|  | clang_getFileLocation(ResultLoc, &ResultFile, &ResultLine, | 
|  | &ResultColumn, nullptr); | 
|  | SearchFileName = clang_getFileName(SearchFile); | 
|  | ResultFileName = clang_getFileName(ResultFile); | 
|  | KindSpelling = clang_getCursorKindSpelling(Result.kind); | 
|  | USR = clang_getCursorUSR(Result); | 
|  | *Log << llvm::format("(%s:%d:%d) = %s", | 
|  | clang_getCString(SearchFileName), SearchLine, SearchColumn, | 
|  | clang_getCString(KindSpelling)) | 
|  | << llvm::format("(%s:%d:%d):%s%s", | 
|  | clang_getCString(ResultFileName), ResultLine, ResultColumn, | 
|  | clang_getCString(USR), IsDef); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(SearchFileName); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(ResultFileName); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(KindSpelling); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(USR); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor Definition = clang_getCursorDefinition(Result); | 
|  | if (!clang_equalCursors(Definition, clang_getNullCursor())) { | 
|  | CXSourceLocation DefinitionLoc = clang_getCursorLocation(Definition); | 
|  | CXString DefinitionKindSpelling | 
|  | = clang_getCursorKindSpelling(Definition.kind); | 
|  | CXFile DefinitionFile; | 
|  | unsigned DefinitionLine, DefinitionColumn; | 
|  | clang_getFileLocation(DefinitionLoc, &DefinitionFile, | 
|  | &DefinitionLine, &DefinitionColumn, nullptr); | 
|  | CXString DefinitionFileName = clang_getFileName(DefinitionFile); | 
|  | *Log << llvm::format("  -> %s(%s:%d:%d)", | 
|  | clang_getCString(DefinitionKindSpelling), | 
|  | clang_getCString(DefinitionFileName), | 
|  | DefinitionLine, DefinitionColumn); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(DefinitionFileName); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(DefinitionKindSpelling); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getNullCursor(void) { | 
|  | return MakeCXCursorInvalid(CXCursor_InvalidFile); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_equalCursors(CXCursor X, CXCursor Y) { | 
|  | // Clear out the "FirstInDeclGroup" part in a declaration cursor, since we | 
|  | // can't set consistently. For example, when visiting a DeclStmt we will set | 
|  | // it but we don't set it on the result of clang_getCursorDefinition for | 
|  | // a reference of the same declaration. | 
|  | // FIXME: Setting "FirstInDeclGroup" in CXCursors is a hack that only works | 
|  | // when visiting a DeclStmt currently, the AST should be enhanced to be able | 
|  | // to provide that kind of info. | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(X.kind)) | 
|  | X.data[1] = nullptr; | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(Y.kind)) | 
|  | Y.data[1] = nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return X == Y; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_hashCursor(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | unsigned Index = 0; | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(C.kind) || clang_isStatement(C.kind)) | 
|  | Index = 1; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return llvm::DenseMapInfo<std::pair<unsigned, const void*> >::getHashValue( | 
|  | std::make_pair(C.kind, C.data[Index])); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isInvalid(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | return K >= CXCursor_FirstInvalid && K <= CXCursor_LastInvalid; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isDeclaration(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | return (K >= CXCursor_FirstDecl && K <= CXCursor_LastDecl) || | 
|  | (K >= CXCursor_FirstExtraDecl && K <= CXCursor_LastExtraDecl); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isInvalidDeclaration(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) { | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C)) | 
|  | return D->isInvalidDecl(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isReference(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | return K >= CXCursor_FirstRef && K <= CXCursor_LastRef; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isExpression(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | return K >= CXCursor_FirstExpr && K <= CXCursor_LastExpr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isStatement(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | return K >= CXCursor_FirstStmt && K <= CXCursor_LastStmt; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isAttribute(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | return K >= CXCursor_FirstAttr && K <= CXCursor_LastAttr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isTranslationUnit(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | return K == CXCursor_TranslationUnit; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isPreprocessing(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | return K >= CXCursor_FirstPreprocessing && K <= CXCursor_LastPreprocessing; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isUnexposed(enum CXCursorKind K) { | 
|  | switch (K) { | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnexposedDecl: | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnexposedExpr: | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnexposedStmt: | 
|  | case CXCursor_UnexposedAttr: | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | default: | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursorKind clang_getCursorKind(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | return C.kind; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceLocation clang_getCursorLocation(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isReference(C.kind)) { | 
|  | switch (C.kind) { | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, SourceLocation> P | 
|  | = getCursorObjCSuperClassRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const ObjCProtocolDecl *, SourceLocation> P | 
|  | = getCursorObjCProtocolRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, SourceLocation> P | 
|  | = getCursorObjCClassRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_TypeRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const TypeDecl *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorTypeRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_TemplateRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const TemplateDecl *, SourceLocation> P = | 
|  | getCursorTemplateRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_NamespaceRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const NamedDecl *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorNamespaceRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_MemberRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const FieldDecl *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorMemberRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_VariableRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const VarDecl *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorVariableRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(P.first->getASTContext(), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier: { | 
|  | const CXXBaseSpecifier *BaseSpec = getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(C); | 
|  | if (!BaseSpec) | 
|  | return clang_getNullLocation(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = BaseSpec->getTypeSourceInfo()) | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), | 
|  | TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), | 
|  | BaseSpec->getLocStart()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_LabelRef: { | 
|  | std::pair<const LabelStmt *, SourceLocation> P = getCursorLabelRef(C); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), P.second); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef: | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), | 
|  | getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(C).second); | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | // FIXME: Need a way to enumerate all non-reference cases. | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Missed a reference kind"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(C.kind)) | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), | 
|  | getLocationFromExpr(getCursorExpr(C))); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isStatement(C.kind)) | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), | 
|  | getCursorStmt(C)->getLocStart()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_PreprocessingDirective) { | 
|  | SourceLocation L = cxcursor::getCursorPreprocessingDirective(C).getBegin(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) { | 
|  | SourceLocation L | 
|  | = cxcursor::getCursorMacroExpansion(C).getSourceRange().getBegin(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition) { | 
|  | SourceLocation L = cxcursor::getCursorMacroDefinition(C)->getLocation(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_InclusionDirective) { | 
|  | SourceLocation L | 
|  | = cxcursor::getCursorInclusionDirective(C)->getSourceRange().getBegin(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isAttribute(C.kind)) { | 
|  | SourceLocation L | 
|  | = cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C)->getLocation(); | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), L); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return clang_getNullLocation(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return clang_getNullLocation(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation Loc = D->getLocation(); | 
|  | // FIXME: Multiple variables declared in a single declaration | 
|  | // currently lack the information needed to correctly determine their | 
|  | // ranges when accounting for the type-specifier.  We use context | 
|  | // stored in the CXCursor to determine if the VarDecl is in a DeclGroup, | 
|  | // and if so, whether it is the first decl. | 
|  | if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | if (!cxcursor::isFirstInDeclGroup(C)) | 
|  | Loc = VD->getLocation(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // For ObjC methods, give the start location of the method name. | 
|  | if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) | 
|  | Loc = MD->getSelectorStartLoc(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(getCursorContext(C), Loc); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | } // end extern "C" | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor cxcursor::getCursor(CXTranslationUnit TU, SourceLocation SLoc) { | 
|  | assert(TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Guard against an invalid SourceLocation, or we may assert in one | 
|  | // of the following calls. | 
|  | if (SLoc.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Translate the given source location to make it point at the beginning of | 
|  | // the token under the cursor. | 
|  | SLoc = Lexer::GetBeginningOfToken(SLoc, CXXUnit->getSourceManager(), | 
|  | CXXUnit->getASTContext().getLangOpts()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor Result = MakeCXCursorInvalid(CXCursor_NoDeclFound); | 
|  | if (SLoc.isValid()) { | 
|  | GetCursorData ResultData(CXXUnit->getSourceManager(), SLoc, Result); | 
|  | CursorVisitor CursorVis(TU, GetCursorVisitor, &ResultData, | 
|  | /*VisitPreprocessorLast=*/true, | 
|  | /*VisitIncludedEntities=*/false, | 
|  | SourceLocation(SLoc)); | 
|  | CursorVis.visitFileRegion(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static SourceRange getRawCursorExtent(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isReference(C.kind)) { | 
|  | switch (C.kind) { | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef: | 
|  | return  getCursorObjCSuperClassRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef: | 
|  | return getCursorObjCProtocolRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef: | 
|  | return getCursorObjCClassRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_TypeRef: | 
|  | return getCursorTypeRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_TemplateRef: | 
|  | return getCursorTemplateRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_NamespaceRef: | 
|  | return getCursorNamespaceRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_MemberRef: | 
|  | return getCursorMemberRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier: | 
|  | return getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(C)->getSourceRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_LabelRef: | 
|  | return getCursorLabelRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef: | 
|  | return getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_VariableRef: | 
|  | return getCursorVariableRef(C).second; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | // FIXME: Need a way to enumerate all non-reference cases. | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Missed a reference kind"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(C.kind)) | 
|  | return getCursorExpr(C)->getSourceRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isStatement(C.kind)) | 
|  | return getCursorStmt(C)->getSourceRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isAttribute(C.kind)) | 
|  | return getCursorAttr(C)->getRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_PreprocessingDirective) | 
|  | return cxcursor::getCursorPreprocessingDirective(C); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) { | 
|  | ASTUnit *TU = getCursorASTUnit(C); | 
|  | SourceRange Range = cxcursor::getCursorMacroExpansion(C).getSourceRange(); | 
|  | return TU->mapRangeFromPreamble(Range); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroDefinition) { | 
|  | ASTUnit *TU = getCursorASTUnit(C); | 
|  | SourceRange Range = cxcursor::getCursorMacroDefinition(C)->getSourceRange(); | 
|  | return TU->mapRangeFromPreamble(Range); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_InclusionDirective) { | 
|  | ASTUnit *TU = getCursorASTUnit(C); | 
|  | SourceRange Range = cxcursor::getCursorInclusionDirective(C)->getSourceRange(); | 
|  | return TU->mapRangeFromPreamble(Range); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_TranslationUnit) { | 
|  | ASTUnit *TU = getCursorASTUnit(C); | 
|  | FileID MainID = TU->getSourceManager().getMainFileID(); | 
|  | SourceLocation Start = TU->getSourceManager().getLocForStartOfFile(MainID); | 
|  | SourceLocation End = TU->getSourceManager().getLocForEndOfFile(MainID); | 
|  | return SourceRange(Start, End); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return SourceRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceRange R = D->getSourceRange(); | 
|  | // FIXME: Multiple variables declared in a single declaration | 
|  | // currently lack the information needed to correctly determine their | 
|  | // ranges when accounting for the type-specifier.  We use context | 
|  | // stored in the CXCursor to determine if the VarDecl is in a DeclGroup, | 
|  | // and if so, whether it is the first decl. | 
|  | if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | if (!cxcursor::isFirstInDeclGroup(C)) | 
|  | R.setBegin(VD->getLocation()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | return R; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return SourceRange(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Retrieves the "raw" cursor extent, which is then extended to include | 
|  | /// the decl-specifier-seq for declarations. | 
|  | static SourceRange getFullCursorExtent(CXCursor C, SourceManager &SrcMgr) { | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return SourceRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceRange R = D->getSourceRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Adjust the start of the location for declarations preceded by | 
|  | // declaration specifiers. | 
|  | SourceLocation StartLoc; | 
|  | if (const DeclaratorDecl *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = DD->getTypeSourceInfo()) | 
|  | StartLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getLocStart(); | 
|  | } else if (const TypedefDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = Typedef->getTypeSourceInfo()) | 
|  | StartLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getLocStart(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (StartLoc.isValid() && R.getBegin().isValid() && | 
|  | SrcMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(StartLoc, R.getBegin())) | 
|  | R.setBegin(StartLoc); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: Multiple variables declared in a single declaration | 
|  | // currently lack the information needed to correctly determine their | 
|  | // ranges when accounting for the type-specifier.  We use context | 
|  | // stored in the CXCursor to determine if the VarDecl is in a DeclGroup, | 
|  | // and if so, whether it is the first decl. | 
|  | if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | if (!cxcursor::isFirstInDeclGroup(C)) | 
|  | R.setBegin(VD->getLocation()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return R; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return getRawCursorExtent(C); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceRange clang_getCursorExtent(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | SourceRange R = getRawCursorExtent(C); | 
|  | if (R.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(getCursorContext(C), R); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getCursorReferenced(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind)) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit tu = getCursorTU(C); | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | if (const UsingDecl *Using = dyn_cast<UsingDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(Using, D->getLocation(), tu); | 
|  | if (const ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropImpl = | 
|  | dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyImplDecl>(D)) | 
|  | if (ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = PropImpl->getPropertyDecl()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Property, tu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return C; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(C); | 
|  | const Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E); | 
|  | if (D) { | 
|  | CXCursor declCursor = MakeCXCursor(D, tu); | 
|  | declCursor = getSelectorIdentifierCursor(getSelectorIdentifierIndex(C), | 
|  | declCursor); | 
|  | return declCursor; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const OverloadExpr *Ovl = dyn_cast_or_null<OverloadExpr>(E)) | 
|  | return MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(Ovl, tu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isStatement(C.kind)) { | 
|  | const Stmt *S = getCursorStmt(C); | 
|  | if (const GotoStmt *Goto = dyn_cast_or_null<GotoStmt>(S)) | 
|  | if (LabelDecl *label = Goto->getLabel()) | 
|  | if (LabelStmt *labelS = label->getStmt()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(labelS, getCursorDecl(C), tu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) { | 
|  | if (const MacroDefinitionRecord *Def = | 
|  | getCursorMacroExpansion(C).getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeMacroDefinitionCursor(Def, tu); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!clang_isReference(C.kind)) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (C.kind) { | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCSuperClassRef: | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(getCursorObjCSuperClassRef(C).first, tu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCProtocolRef: { | 
|  | const ObjCProtocolDecl *Prot = getCursorObjCProtocolRef(C).first; | 
|  | if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *Def = Prot->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, tu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Prot, tu); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_ObjCClassRef: { | 
|  | const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = getCursorObjCClassRef(C).first; | 
|  | if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Class->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, tu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Class, tu); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_TypeRef: | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(getCursorTypeRef(C).first, tu ); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_TemplateRef: | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(getCursorTemplateRef(C).first, tu ); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_NamespaceRef: | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(getCursorNamespaceRef(C).first, tu ); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_MemberRef: | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(getCursorMemberRef(C).first, tu ); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_CXXBaseSpecifier: { | 
|  | const CXXBaseSpecifier *B = cxcursor::getCursorCXXBaseSpecifier(C); | 
|  | return clang_getTypeDeclaration(cxtype::MakeCXType(B->getType(), | 
|  | tu )); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_LabelRef: | 
|  | // FIXME: We end up faking the "parent" declaration here because we | 
|  | // don't want to make CXCursor larger. | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(getCursorLabelRef(C).first, | 
|  | cxtu::getASTUnit(tu)->getASTContext() | 
|  | .getTranslationUnitDecl(), | 
|  | tu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef: | 
|  | return C; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_VariableRef: | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(getCursorVariableRef(C).first, tu); | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | // We would prefer to enumerate all non-reference cursor kinds here. | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Unhandled reference cursor kind"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getCursorDefinition(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (clang_isInvalid(C.kind)) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU = getCursorTU(C); | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool WasReference = false; | 
|  | if (clang_isReference(C.kind) || clang_isExpression(C.kind)) { | 
|  | C = clang_getCursorReferenced(C); | 
|  | WasReference = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) | 
|  | return clang_getCursorReferenced(C); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (D->getKind()) { | 
|  | // Declaration kinds that don't really separate the notions of | 
|  | // declaration and definition. | 
|  | case Decl::Namespace: | 
|  | case Decl::Typedef: | 
|  | case Decl::TypeAlias: | 
|  | case Decl::TypeAliasTemplate: | 
|  | case Decl::TemplateTypeParm: | 
|  | case Decl::EnumConstant: | 
|  | case Decl::Field: | 
|  | case Decl::Binding: | 
|  | case Decl::MSProperty: | 
|  | case Decl::IndirectField: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCIvar: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField: | 
|  | case Decl::ImplicitParam: | 
|  | case Decl::ParmVar: | 
|  | case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: | 
|  | case Decl::TemplateTemplateParm: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCImplementation: | 
|  | case Decl::AccessSpec: | 
|  | case Decl::LinkageSpec: | 
|  | case Decl::Export: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCPropertyImpl: | 
|  | case Decl::FileScopeAsm: | 
|  | case Decl::StaticAssert: | 
|  | case Decl::Block: | 
|  | case Decl::Captured: | 
|  | case Decl::OMPCapturedExpr: | 
|  | case Decl::Label:  // FIXME: Is this right?? | 
|  | case Decl::ClassScopeFunctionSpecialization: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXDeductionGuide: | 
|  | case Decl::Import: | 
|  | case Decl::OMPThreadPrivate: | 
|  | case Decl::OMPDeclareReduction: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCTypeParam: | 
|  | case Decl::BuiltinTemplate: | 
|  | case Decl::PragmaComment: | 
|  | case Decl::PragmaDetectMismatch: | 
|  | case Decl::UsingPack: | 
|  | return C; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Declaration kinds that don't make any sense here, but are | 
|  | // nonetheless harmless. | 
|  | case Decl::Empty: | 
|  | case Decl::TranslationUnit: | 
|  | case Decl::ExternCContext: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Declaration kinds for which the definition is not resolvable. | 
|  | case Decl::UnresolvedUsingTypename: | 
|  | case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue: | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::UsingDirective: | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(cast<UsingDirectiveDecl>(D)->getNominatedNamespace(), | 
|  | TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::NamespaceAlias: | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(cast<NamespaceAliasDecl>(D)->getNamespace(), TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::Enum: | 
|  | case Decl::Record: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXRecord: | 
|  | case Decl::ClassTemplateSpecialization: | 
|  | case Decl::ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization: | 
|  | if (TagDecl *Def = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::Function: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXMethod: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXConstructor: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXDestructor: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXConversion: { | 
|  | const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; | 
|  | if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->getBody(Def)) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::Var: | 
|  | case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization: | 
|  | case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization: | 
|  | case Decl::Decomposition: { | 
|  | // Ask the variable if it has a definition. | 
|  | if (const VarDecl *Def = cast<VarDecl>(D)->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::FunctionTemplate: { | 
|  | const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; | 
|  | if (cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)->getTemplatedDecl()->getBody(Def)) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(), TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::ClassTemplate: { | 
|  | if (RecordDecl *Def = cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(D)->getTemplatedDecl() | 
|  | ->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)->getDescribedClassTemplate(), | 
|  | TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::VarTemplate: { | 
|  | if (VarDecl *Def = | 
|  | cast<VarTemplateDecl>(D)->getTemplatedDecl()->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(cast<VarDecl>(Def)->getDescribedVarTemplate(), TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::Using: | 
|  | return MakeCursorOverloadedDeclRef(cast<UsingDecl>(D), | 
|  | D->getLocation(), TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::UsingShadow: | 
|  | case Decl::ConstructorUsingShadow: | 
|  | return clang_getCursorDefinition( | 
|  | MakeCXCursor(cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(), | 
|  | TU)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCMethod: { | 
|  | const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D); | 
|  | if (Method->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) | 
|  | return C; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Dig out the method definition in the associated | 
|  | // @implementation, if we have it. | 
|  | // FIXME: The ASTs should make finding the definition easier. | 
|  | if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class | 
|  | = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())) | 
|  | if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpl = Class->getImplementation()) | 
|  | if (ObjCMethodDecl *Def = ClassImpl->getMethod(Method->getSelector(), | 
|  | Method->isInstanceMethod())) | 
|  | if (Def->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCCategory: | 
|  | if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl *Impl | 
|  | = cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)->getImplementation()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Impl, TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCProtocol: | 
|  | if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *Def = cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(D)->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCInterface: { | 
|  | // There are two notions of a "definition" for an Objective-C | 
|  | // class: the interface and its implementation. When we resolved a | 
|  | // reference to an Objective-C class, produce the @interface as | 
|  | // the definition; when we were provided with the interface, | 
|  | // produce the @implementation as the definition. | 
|  | const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D); | 
|  | if (WasReference) { | 
|  | if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = IFace->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU); | 
|  | } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *Impl = IFace->getImplementation()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Impl, TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCProperty: | 
|  | // FIXME: We don't really know where to find the | 
|  | // ObjCPropertyImplDecls that implement this property. | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCCompatibleAlias: | 
|  | if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class | 
|  | = cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(D)->getClassInterface()) | 
|  | if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Class->getDefinition()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(Def, TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::Friend: | 
|  | if (NamedDecl *Friend = cast<FriendDecl>(D)->getFriendDecl()) | 
|  | return clang_getCursorDefinition(MakeCXCursor(Friend, TU)); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case Decl::FriendTemplate: | 
|  | if (NamedDecl *Friend = cast<FriendTemplateDecl>(D)->getFriendDecl()) | 
|  | return clang_getCursorDefinition(MakeCXCursor(Friend, TU)); | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_isCursorDefinition(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getCursorDefinition(C) == C; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getCanonicalCursor(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return C; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C)) { | 
|  | if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CatImplD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(D)) | 
|  | if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD = CatImplD->getCategoryDecl()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(CatD, getCursorTU(C)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const ObjCImplDecl *ImplD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(D)) | 
|  | if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFD = ImplD->getClassInterface()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(IFD, getCursorTU(C)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(D->getCanonicalDecl(), getCursorTU(C)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return C; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_Cursor_getObjCSelectorIndex(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | return cxcursor::getSelectorIdentifierIndexAndLoc(cursor).first; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_getNumOverloadedDecls(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (C.kind != CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | OverloadedDeclRefStorage Storage = getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(C).first; | 
|  | if (const OverloadExpr *E = Storage.dyn_cast<const OverloadExpr *>()) | 
|  | return E->getNumDecls(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *S | 
|  | = Storage.dyn_cast<OverloadedTemplateStorage*>()) | 
|  | return S->size(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = Storage.get<const Decl *>(); | 
|  | if (const UsingDecl *Using = dyn_cast<UsingDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return Using->shadow_size(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getOverloadedDecl(CXCursor cursor, unsigned index) { | 
|  | if (cursor.kind != CXCursor_OverloadedDeclRef) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (index >= clang_getNumOverloadedDecls(cursor)) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU = getCursorTU(cursor); | 
|  | OverloadedDeclRefStorage Storage = getCursorOverloadedDeclRef(cursor).first; | 
|  | if (const OverloadExpr *E = Storage.dyn_cast<const OverloadExpr *>()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(E->decls_begin()[index], TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *S | 
|  | = Storage.dyn_cast<OverloadedTemplateStorage*>()) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(S->begin()[index], TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = Storage.get<const Decl *>(); | 
|  | if (const UsingDecl *Using = dyn_cast<UsingDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | // FIXME: This is, unfortunately, linear time. | 
|  | UsingDecl::shadow_iterator Pos = Using->shadow_begin(); | 
|  | std::advance(Pos, index); | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Pos)->getTargetDecl(), TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_getDefinitionSpellingAndExtent(CXCursor C, | 
|  | const char **startBuf, | 
|  | const char **endBuf, | 
|  | unsigned *startLine, | 
|  | unsigned *startColumn, | 
|  | unsigned *endLine, | 
|  | unsigned *endColumn) { | 
|  | assert(getCursorDecl(C) && "CXCursor has null decl"); | 
|  | const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(getCursorDecl(C)); | 
|  | CompoundStmt *Body = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(FD->getBody()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = FD->getASTContext().getSourceManager(); | 
|  | *startBuf = SM.getCharacterData(Body->getLBracLoc()); | 
|  | *endBuf = SM.getCharacterData(Body->getRBracLoc()); | 
|  | *startLine = SM.getSpellingLineNumber(Body->getLBracLoc()); | 
|  | *startColumn = SM.getSpellingColumnNumber(Body->getLBracLoc()); | 
|  | *endLine = SM.getSpellingLineNumber(Body->getRBracLoc()); | 
|  | *endColumn = SM.getSpellingColumnNumber(Body->getRBracLoc()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceRange clang_getCursorReferenceNameRange(CXCursor C, unsigned NameFlags, | 
|  | unsigned PieceIndex) { | 
|  | RefNamePieces Pieces; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (C.kind) { | 
|  | case CXCursor_MemberRefExpr: | 
|  | if (const MemberExpr *E = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(getCursorExpr(C))) | 
|  | Pieces = buildPieces(NameFlags, true, E->getMemberNameInfo(), | 
|  | E->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange()); | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_DeclRefExpr: | 
|  | if (const DeclRefExpr *E = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(getCursorExpr(C))) { | 
|  | SourceRange TemplateArgLoc(E->getLAngleLoc(), E->getRAngleLoc()); | 
|  | Pieces = | 
|  | buildPieces(NameFlags, false, E->getNameInfo(), | 
|  | E->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(), &TemplateArgLoc); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXCursor_CallExpr: | 
|  | if (const CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = | 
|  | dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(getCursorExpr(C))) { | 
|  | const Expr *Callee = OCE->getCallee(); | 
|  | if (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Callee)) | 
|  | Callee = ICE->getSubExpr(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Callee)) | 
|  | Pieces = buildPieces(NameFlags, false, DRE->getNameInfo(), | 
|  | DRE->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Pieces.empty()) { | 
|  | if (PieceIndex == 0) | 
|  | return clang_getCursorExtent(C); | 
|  | } else if (PieceIndex < Pieces.size()) { | 
|  | SourceRange R = Pieces[PieceIndex]; | 
|  | if (R.isValid()) | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(getCursorContext(C), R); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_enableStackTraces(void) { | 
|  | // FIXME: Provide an argv0 here so we can find llvm-symbolizer. | 
|  | llvm::sys::PrintStackTraceOnErrorSignal(StringRef()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_executeOnThread(void (*fn)(void*), void *user_data, | 
|  | unsigned stack_size) { | 
|  | llvm::llvm_execute_on_thread(fn, user_data, stack_size); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Token-based Operations. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | /* CXToken layout: | 
|  | *   int_data[0]: a CXTokenKind | 
|  | *   int_data[1]: starting token location | 
|  | *   int_data[2]: token length | 
|  | *   int_data[3]: reserved | 
|  | *   ptr_data: for identifiers and keywords, an IdentifierInfo*. | 
|  | *   otherwise unused. | 
|  | */ | 
|  | CXTokenKind clang_getTokenKind(CXToken CXTok) { | 
|  | return static_cast<CXTokenKind>(CXTok.int_data[0]); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_getTokenSpelling(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXToken CXTok) { | 
|  | switch (clang_getTokenKind(CXTok)) { | 
|  | case CXToken_Identifier: | 
|  | case CXToken_Keyword: | 
|  | // We know we have an IdentifierInfo*, so use that. | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(static_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(CXTok.ptr_data) | 
|  | ->getNameStart()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXToken_Literal: { | 
|  | // We have stashed the starting pointer in the ptr_data field. Use it. | 
|  | const char *Text = static_cast<const char *>(CXTok.ptr_data); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(StringRef(Text, CXTok.int_data[2])); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | case CXToken_Punctuation: | 
|  | case CXToken_Comment: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // We have to find the starting buffer pointer the hard way, by | 
|  | // deconstructing the source location. | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(CXTok.int_data[1]); | 
|  | std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo | 
|  | = CXXUnit->getSourceManager().getDecomposedSpellingLoc(Loc); | 
|  | bool Invalid = false; | 
|  | StringRef Buffer | 
|  | = CXXUnit->getSourceManager().getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid); | 
|  | if (Invalid) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Buffer.substr(LocInfo.second, CXTok.int_data[2])); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceLocation clang_getTokenLocation(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXToken CXTok) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullLocation(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit) | 
|  | return clang_getNullLocation(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceLocation(CXXUnit->getASTContext(), | 
|  | SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(CXTok.int_data[1])); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceRange clang_getTokenExtent(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXToken CXTok) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(CXXUnit->getASTContext(), | 
|  | SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(CXTok.int_data[1])); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void getTokens(ASTUnit *CXXUnit, SourceRange Range, | 
|  | SmallVectorImpl<CXToken> &CXTokens) { | 
|  | SourceManager &SourceMgr = CXXUnit->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | std::pair<FileID, unsigned> BeginLocInfo | 
|  | = SourceMgr.getDecomposedSpellingLoc(Range.getBegin()); | 
|  | std::pair<FileID, unsigned> EndLocInfo | 
|  | = SourceMgr.getDecomposedSpellingLoc(Range.getEnd()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Cannot tokenize across files. | 
|  | if (BeginLocInfo.first != EndLocInfo.first) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Create a lexer | 
|  | bool Invalid = false; | 
|  | StringRef Buffer | 
|  | = SourceMgr.getBufferData(BeginLocInfo.first, &Invalid); | 
|  | if (Invalid) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | Lexer Lex(SourceMgr.getLocForStartOfFile(BeginLocInfo.first), | 
|  | CXXUnit->getASTContext().getLangOpts(), | 
|  | Buffer.begin(), Buffer.data() + BeginLocInfo.second, Buffer.end()); | 
|  | Lex.SetCommentRetentionState(true); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Lex tokens until we hit the end of the range. | 
|  | const char *EffectiveBufferEnd = Buffer.data() + EndLocInfo.second; | 
|  | Token Tok; | 
|  | bool previousWasAt = false; | 
|  | do { | 
|  | // Lex the next token | 
|  | Lex.LexFromRawLexer(Tok); | 
|  | if (Tok.is(tok::eof)) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Initialize the CXToken. | 
|  | CXToken CXTok; | 
|  |  | 
|  | //   - Common fields | 
|  | CXTok.int_data[1] = Tok.getLocation().getRawEncoding(); | 
|  | CXTok.int_data[2] = Tok.getLength(); | 
|  | CXTok.int_data[3] = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | //   - Kind-specific fields | 
|  | if (Tok.isLiteral()) { | 
|  | CXTok.int_data[0] = CXToken_Literal; | 
|  | CXTok.ptr_data = const_cast<char *>(Tok.getLiteralData()); | 
|  | } else if (Tok.is(tok::raw_identifier)) { | 
|  | // Lookup the identifier to determine whether we have a keyword. | 
|  | IdentifierInfo *II | 
|  | = CXXUnit->getPreprocessor().LookUpIdentifierInfo(Tok); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((II->getObjCKeywordID() != tok::objc_not_keyword) && previousWasAt) { | 
|  | CXTok.int_data[0] = CXToken_Keyword; | 
|  | } | 
|  | else { | 
|  | CXTok.int_data[0] = Tok.is(tok::identifier) | 
|  | ? CXToken_Identifier | 
|  | : CXToken_Keyword; | 
|  | } | 
|  | CXTok.ptr_data = II; | 
|  | } else if (Tok.is(tok::comment)) { | 
|  | CXTok.int_data[0] = CXToken_Comment; | 
|  | CXTok.ptr_data = nullptr; | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | CXTok.int_data[0] = CXToken_Punctuation; | 
|  | CXTok.ptr_data = nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | CXTokens.push_back(CXTok); | 
|  | previousWasAt = Tok.is(tok::at); | 
|  | } while (Lex.getBufferLocation() < EffectiveBufferEnd); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXToken *clang_getToken(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXSourceLocation Location) { | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { | 
|  | *Log << TU << ' ' << Location; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation Begin = cxloc::translateSourceLocation(Location); | 
|  | if (Begin.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = CXXUnit->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DecomposedEnd = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Begin); | 
|  | DecomposedEnd.second += Lexer::MeasureTokenLength(Begin, SM, CXXUnit->getLangOpts()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation End = SM.getComposedLoc(DecomposedEnd.first, DecomposedEnd.second); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SmallVector<CXToken, 32> CXTokens; | 
|  | getTokens(CXXUnit, SourceRange(Begin, End), CXTokens); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (CXTokens.empty()) | 
|  | return NULL; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTokens.resize(1); | 
|  | CXToken *Token = static_cast<CXToken *>(llvm::safe_malloc(sizeof(CXToken))); | 
|  |  | 
|  | memmove(Token, CXTokens.data(), sizeof(CXToken)); | 
|  | return Token; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_tokenize(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXSourceRange Range, | 
|  | CXToken **Tokens, unsigned *NumTokens) { | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { | 
|  | *Log << TU << ' ' << Range; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Tokens) | 
|  | *Tokens = nullptr; | 
|  | if (NumTokens) | 
|  | *NumTokens = 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit || !Tokens || !NumTokens) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit); | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceRange R = cxloc::translateCXSourceRange(Range); | 
|  | if (R.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | SmallVector<CXToken, 32> CXTokens; | 
|  | getTokens(CXXUnit, R, CXTokens); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (CXTokens.empty()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | *Tokens = static_cast<CXToken *>( | 
|  | llvm::safe_malloc(sizeof(CXToken) * CXTokens.size())); | 
|  | memmove(*Tokens, CXTokens.data(), sizeof(CXToken) * CXTokens.size()); | 
|  | *NumTokens = CXTokens.size(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_disposeTokens(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | CXToken *Tokens, unsigned NumTokens) { | 
|  | free(Tokens); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Token annotation APIs. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum CXChildVisitResult AnnotateTokensVisitor(CXCursor cursor, | 
|  | CXCursor parent, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data); | 
|  | static bool AnnotateTokensPostChildrenVisitor(CXCursor cursor, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data); | 
|  |  | 
|  | namespace { | 
|  | class AnnotateTokensWorker { | 
|  | CXToken *Tokens; | 
|  | CXCursor *Cursors; | 
|  | unsigned NumTokens; | 
|  | unsigned TokIdx; | 
|  | unsigned PreprocessingTokIdx; | 
|  | CursorVisitor AnnotateVis; | 
|  | SourceManager &SrcMgr; | 
|  | bool HasContextSensitiveKeywords; | 
|  |  | 
|  | struct PostChildrenInfo { | 
|  | CXCursor Cursor; | 
|  | SourceRange CursorRange; | 
|  | unsigned BeforeReachingCursorIdx; | 
|  | unsigned BeforeChildrenTokenIdx; | 
|  | }; | 
|  | SmallVector<PostChildrenInfo, 8> PostChildrenInfos; | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXToken &getTok(unsigned Idx) { | 
|  | assert(Idx < NumTokens); | 
|  | return Tokens[Idx]; | 
|  | } | 
|  | const CXToken &getTok(unsigned Idx) const { | 
|  | assert(Idx < NumTokens); | 
|  | return Tokens[Idx]; | 
|  | } | 
|  | bool MoreTokens() const { return TokIdx < NumTokens; } | 
|  | unsigned NextToken() const { return TokIdx; } | 
|  | void AdvanceToken() { ++TokIdx; } | 
|  | SourceLocation GetTokenLoc(unsigned tokI) { | 
|  | return SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(getTok(tokI).int_data[1]); | 
|  | } | 
|  | bool isFunctionMacroToken(unsigned tokI) const { | 
|  | return getTok(tokI).int_data[3] != 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | SourceLocation getFunctionMacroTokenLoc(unsigned tokI) const { | 
|  | return SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(getTok(tokI).int_data[3]); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void annotateAndAdvanceTokens(CXCursor, RangeComparisonResult, SourceRange); | 
|  | bool annotateAndAdvanceFunctionMacroTokens(CXCursor, RangeComparisonResult, | 
|  | SourceRange); | 
|  |  | 
|  | public: | 
|  | AnnotateTokensWorker(CXToken *tokens, CXCursor *cursors, unsigned numTokens, | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU, SourceRange RegionOfInterest) | 
|  | : Tokens(tokens), Cursors(cursors), | 
|  | NumTokens(numTokens), TokIdx(0), PreprocessingTokIdx(0), | 
|  | AnnotateVis(TU, | 
|  | AnnotateTokensVisitor, this, | 
|  | /*VisitPreprocessorLast=*/true, | 
|  | /*VisitIncludedEntities=*/false, | 
|  | RegionOfInterest, | 
|  | /*VisitDeclsOnly=*/false, | 
|  | AnnotateTokensPostChildrenVisitor), | 
|  | SrcMgr(cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->getSourceManager()), | 
|  | HasContextSensitiveKeywords(false) { } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void VisitChildren(CXCursor C) { AnnotateVis.VisitChildren(C); } | 
|  | enum CXChildVisitResult Visit(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent); | 
|  | bool postVisitChildren(CXCursor cursor); | 
|  | void AnnotateTokens(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Determine whether the annotator saw any cursors that have | 
|  | /// context-sensitive keywords. | 
|  | bool hasContextSensitiveKeywords() const { | 
|  | return HasContextSensitiveKeywords; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ~AnnotateTokensWorker() { | 
|  | assert(PostChildrenInfos.empty()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void AnnotateTokensWorker::AnnotateTokens() { | 
|  | // Walk the AST within the region of interest, annotating tokens | 
|  | // along the way. | 
|  | AnnotateVis.visitFileRegion(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void updateCursorAnnotation(CXCursor &Cursor, | 
|  | const CXCursor &updateC) { | 
|  | if (clang_isInvalid(updateC.kind) || !clang_isInvalid(Cursor.kind)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  | Cursor = updateC; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// It annotates and advances tokens with a cursor until the comparison | 
|  | //// between the cursor location and the source range is the same as | 
|  | /// \arg compResult. | 
|  | /// | 
|  | /// Pass RangeBefore to annotate tokens with a cursor until a range is reached. | 
|  | /// Pass RangeOverlap to annotate tokens inside a range. | 
|  | void AnnotateTokensWorker::annotateAndAdvanceTokens(CXCursor updateC, | 
|  | RangeComparisonResult compResult, | 
|  | SourceRange range) { | 
|  | while (MoreTokens()) { | 
|  | const unsigned I = NextToken(); | 
|  | if (isFunctionMacroToken(I)) | 
|  | if (!annotateAndAdvanceFunctionMacroTokens(updateC, compResult, range)) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation TokLoc = GetTokenLoc(I); | 
|  | if (LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokLoc, range) == compResult) { | 
|  | updateCursorAnnotation(Cursors[I], updateC); | 
|  | AdvanceToken(); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Special annotation handling for macro argument tokens. | 
|  | /// \returns true if it advanced beyond all macro tokens, false otherwise. | 
|  | bool AnnotateTokensWorker::annotateAndAdvanceFunctionMacroTokens( | 
|  | CXCursor updateC, | 
|  | RangeComparisonResult compResult, | 
|  | SourceRange range) { | 
|  | assert(MoreTokens()); | 
|  | assert(isFunctionMacroToken(NextToken()) && | 
|  | "Should be called only for macro arg tokens"); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // This works differently than annotateAndAdvanceTokens; because expanded | 
|  | // macro arguments can have arbitrary translation-unit source order, we do not | 
|  | // advance the token index one by one until a token fails the range test. | 
|  | // We only advance once past all of the macro arg tokens if all of them | 
|  | // pass the range test. If one of them fails we keep the token index pointing | 
|  | // at the start of the macro arg tokens so that the failing token will be | 
|  | // annotated by a subsequent annotation try. | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool atLeastOneCompFail = false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned I = NextToken(); | 
|  | for (; I < NumTokens && isFunctionMacroToken(I); ++I) { | 
|  | SourceLocation TokLoc = getFunctionMacroTokenLoc(I); | 
|  | if (TokLoc.isFileID()) | 
|  | continue; // not macro arg token, it's parens or comma. | 
|  | if (LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokLoc, range) == compResult) { | 
|  | if (clang_isInvalid(clang_getCursorKind(Cursors[I]))) | 
|  | Cursors[I] = updateC; | 
|  | } else | 
|  | atLeastOneCompFail = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (atLeastOneCompFail) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | TokIdx = I; // All of the tokens were handled, advance beyond all of them. | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum CXChildVisitResult | 
|  | AnnotateTokensWorker::Visit(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent) { | 
|  | SourceRange cursorRange = getRawCursorExtent(cursor); | 
|  | if (cursorRange.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Recurse; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!HasContextSensitiveKeywords) { | 
|  | // Objective-C properties can have context-sensitive keywords. | 
|  | if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl) { | 
|  | if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *Property | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCPropertyDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) | 
|  | HasContextSensitiveKeywords = Property->getPropertyAttributesAsWritten() != 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | // Objective-C methods can have context-sensitive keywords. | 
|  | else if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl || | 
|  | cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl) { | 
|  | if (const ObjCMethodDecl *Method | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) { | 
|  | if (Method->getObjCDeclQualifier()) | 
|  | HasContextSensitiveKeywords = true; | 
|  | else { | 
|  | for (const auto *P : Method->parameters()) { | 
|  | if (P->getObjCDeclQualifier()) { | 
|  | HasContextSensitiveKeywords = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | // C++ methods can have context-sensitive keywords. | 
|  | else if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_CXXMethod) { | 
|  | if (const CXXMethodDecl *Method | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(getCursorDecl(cursor))) { | 
|  | if (Method->hasAttr<FinalAttr>() || Method->hasAttr<OverrideAttr>()) | 
|  | HasContextSensitiveKeywords = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | // C++ classes can have context-sensitive keywords. | 
|  | else if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_StructDecl || | 
|  | cursor.kind == CXCursor_ClassDecl || | 
|  | cursor.kind == CXCursor_ClassTemplate || | 
|  | cursor.kind == CXCursor_ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization) { | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor)) | 
|  | if (D->hasAttr<FinalAttr>()) | 
|  | HasContextSensitiveKeywords = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Don't override a property annotation with its getter/setter method. | 
|  | if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl && | 
|  | parent.kind == CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isPreprocessing(cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | // Items in the preprocessing record are kept separate from items in | 
|  | // declarations, so we keep a separate token index. | 
|  | unsigned SavedTokIdx = TokIdx; | 
|  | TokIdx = PreprocessingTokIdx; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Skip tokens up until we catch up to the beginning of the preprocessing | 
|  | // entry. | 
|  | while (MoreTokens()) { | 
|  | const unsigned I = NextToken(); | 
|  | SourceLocation TokLoc = GetTokenLoc(I); | 
|  | switch (LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokLoc, cursorRange)) { | 
|  | case RangeBefore: | 
|  | AdvanceToken(); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | case RangeAfter: | 
|  | case RangeOverlap: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Look at all of the tokens within this range. | 
|  | while (MoreTokens()) { | 
|  | const unsigned I = NextToken(); | 
|  | SourceLocation TokLoc = GetTokenLoc(I); | 
|  | switch (LocationCompare(SrcMgr, TokLoc, cursorRange)) { | 
|  | case RangeBefore: | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Infeasible"); | 
|  | case RangeAfter: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case RangeOverlap: | 
|  | // For macro expansions, just note where the beginning of the macro | 
|  | // expansion occurs. | 
|  | if (cursor.kind == CXCursor_MacroExpansion) { | 
|  | if (TokLoc == cursorRange.getBegin()) | 
|  | Cursors[I] = cursor; | 
|  | AdvanceToken(); | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | // We may have already annotated macro names inside macro definitions. | 
|  | if (Cursors[I].kind != CXCursor_MacroExpansion) | 
|  | Cursors[I] = cursor; | 
|  | AdvanceToken(); | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Save the preprocessing token index; restore the non-preprocessing | 
|  | // token index. | 
|  | PreprocessingTokIdx = TokIdx; | 
|  | TokIdx = SavedTokIdx; | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Recurse; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (cursorRange.isInvalid()) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned BeforeReachingCursorIdx = NextToken(); | 
|  | const enum CXCursorKind cursorK = clang_getCursorKind(cursor); | 
|  | const enum CXCursorKind K = clang_getCursorKind(parent); | 
|  | const CXCursor updateC = | 
|  | (clang_isInvalid(K) || K == CXCursor_TranslationUnit || | 
|  | // Attributes are annotated out-of-order, skip tokens until we reach it. | 
|  | clang_isAttribute(cursor.kind)) | 
|  | ? clang_getNullCursor() : parent; | 
|  |  | 
|  | annotateAndAdvanceTokens(updateC, RangeBefore, cursorRange); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Avoid having the cursor of an expression "overwrite" the annotation of the | 
|  | // variable declaration that it belongs to. | 
|  | // This can happen for C++ constructor expressions whose range generally | 
|  | // include the variable declaration, e.g.: | 
|  | //  MyCXXClass foo; // Make sure we don't annotate 'foo' as a CallExpr cursor. | 
|  | if (clang_isExpression(cursorK) && MoreTokens()) { | 
|  | const Expr *E = getCursorExpr(cursor); | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = getCursorParentDecl(cursor)) { | 
|  | const unsigned I = NextToken(); | 
|  | if (E->getLocStart().isValid() && D->getLocation().isValid() && | 
|  | E->getLocStart() == D->getLocation() && | 
|  | E->getLocStart() == GetTokenLoc(I)) { | 
|  | updateCursorAnnotation(Cursors[I], updateC); | 
|  | AdvanceToken(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Before recursing into the children keep some state that we are going | 
|  | // to use in the AnnotateTokensWorker::postVisitChildren callback to do some | 
|  | // extra work after the child nodes are visited. | 
|  | // Note that we don't call VisitChildren here to avoid traversing statements | 
|  | // code-recursively which can blow the stack. | 
|  |  | 
|  | PostChildrenInfo Info; | 
|  | Info.Cursor = cursor; | 
|  | Info.CursorRange = cursorRange; | 
|  | Info.BeforeReachingCursorIdx = BeforeReachingCursorIdx; | 
|  | Info.BeforeChildrenTokenIdx = NextToken(); | 
|  | PostChildrenInfos.push_back(Info); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Recurse; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool AnnotateTokensWorker::postVisitChildren(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | if (PostChildrenInfos.empty()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | const PostChildrenInfo &Info = PostChildrenInfos.back(); | 
|  | if (!clang_equalCursors(Info.Cursor, cursor)) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const unsigned BeforeChildren = Info.BeforeChildrenTokenIdx; | 
|  | const unsigned AfterChildren = NextToken(); | 
|  | SourceRange cursorRange = Info.CursorRange; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Scan the tokens that are at the end of the cursor, but are not captured | 
|  | // but the child cursors. | 
|  | annotateAndAdvanceTokens(cursor, RangeOverlap, cursorRange); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Scan the tokens that are at the beginning of the cursor, but are not | 
|  | // capture by the child cursors. | 
|  | for (unsigned I = BeforeChildren; I != AfterChildren; ++I) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isInvalid(clang_getCursorKind(Cursors[I]))) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | Cursors[I] = cursor; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Attributes are annotated out-of-order, rewind TokIdx to when we first | 
|  | // encountered the attribute cursor. | 
|  | if (clang_isAttribute(cursor.kind)) | 
|  | TokIdx = Info.BeforeReachingCursorIdx; | 
|  |  | 
|  | PostChildrenInfos.pop_back(); | 
|  | return false; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static enum CXChildVisitResult AnnotateTokensVisitor(CXCursor cursor, | 
|  | CXCursor parent, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data) { | 
|  | return static_cast<AnnotateTokensWorker*>(client_data)->Visit(cursor, parent); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static bool AnnotateTokensPostChildrenVisitor(CXCursor cursor, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data) { | 
|  | return static_cast<AnnotateTokensWorker*>(client_data)-> | 
|  | postVisitChildren(cursor); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | namespace { | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Uses the macro expansions in the preprocessing record to find | 
|  | /// and mark tokens that are macro arguments. This info is used by the | 
|  | /// AnnotateTokensWorker. | 
|  | class MarkMacroArgTokensVisitor { | 
|  | SourceManager &SM; | 
|  | CXToken *Tokens; | 
|  | unsigned NumTokens; | 
|  | unsigned CurIdx; | 
|  |  | 
|  | public: | 
|  | MarkMacroArgTokensVisitor(SourceManager &SM, | 
|  | CXToken *tokens, unsigned numTokens) | 
|  | : SM(SM), Tokens(tokens), NumTokens(numTokens), CurIdx(0) { } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXChildVisitResult visit(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent) { | 
|  | if (cursor.kind != CXCursor_MacroExpansion) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceRange macroRange = getCursorMacroExpansion(cursor).getSourceRange(); | 
|  | if (macroRange.getBegin() == macroRange.getEnd()) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Continue; // it's not a function macro. | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; CurIdx < NumTokens; ++CurIdx) { | 
|  | if (!SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(getTokenLoc(CurIdx), | 
|  | macroRange.getBegin())) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (CurIdx == NumTokens) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; CurIdx < NumTokens; ++CurIdx) { | 
|  | SourceLocation tokLoc = getTokenLoc(CurIdx); | 
|  | if (!SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(tokLoc, macroRange.getEnd())) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | setFunctionMacroTokenLoc(CurIdx, SM.getMacroArgExpandedLocation(tokLoc)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (CurIdx == NumTokens) | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXChildVisit_Continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | private: | 
|  | CXToken &getTok(unsigned Idx) { | 
|  | assert(Idx < NumTokens); | 
|  | return Tokens[Idx]; | 
|  | } | 
|  | const CXToken &getTok(unsigned Idx) const { | 
|  | assert(Idx < NumTokens); | 
|  | return Tokens[Idx]; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation getTokenLoc(unsigned tokI) { | 
|  | return SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(getTok(tokI).int_data[1]); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void setFunctionMacroTokenLoc(unsigned tokI, SourceLocation loc) { | 
|  | // The third field is reserved and currently not used. Use it here | 
|  | // to mark macro arg expanded tokens with their expanded locations. | 
|  | getTok(tokI).int_data[3] = loc.getRawEncoding(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | } // end anonymous namespace | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CXChildVisitResult | 
|  | MarkMacroArgTokensVisitorDelegate(CXCursor cursor, CXCursor parent, | 
|  | CXClientData client_data) { | 
|  | return static_cast<MarkMacroArgTokensVisitor*>(client_data)->visit(cursor, | 
|  | parent); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Used by \c annotatePreprocessorTokens. | 
|  | /// \returns true if lexing was finished, false otherwise. | 
|  | static bool lexNext(Lexer &Lex, Token &Tok, | 
|  | unsigned &NextIdx, unsigned NumTokens) { | 
|  | if (NextIdx >= NumTokens) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ++NextIdx; | 
|  | Lex.LexFromRawLexer(Tok); | 
|  | return Tok.is(tok::eof); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void annotatePreprocessorTokens(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | SourceRange RegionOfInterest, | 
|  | CXCursor *Cursors, | 
|  | CXToken *Tokens, | 
|  | unsigned NumTokens) { | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | Preprocessor &PP = CXXUnit->getPreprocessor(); | 
|  | SourceManager &SourceMgr = CXXUnit->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | std::pair<FileID, unsigned> BeginLocInfo | 
|  | = SourceMgr.getDecomposedSpellingLoc(RegionOfInterest.getBegin()); | 
|  | std::pair<FileID, unsigned> EndLocInfo | 
|  | = SourceMgr.getDecomposedSpellingLoc(RegionOfInterest.getEnd()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (BeginLocInfo.first != EndLocInfo.first) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | StringRef Buffer; | 
|  | bool Invalid = false; | 
|  | Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(BeginLocInfo.first, &Invalid); | 
|  | if (Buffer.empty() || Invalid) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | Lexer Lex(SourceMgr.getLocForStartOfFile(BeginLocInfo.first), | 
|  | CXXUnit->getASTContext().getLangOpts(), | 
|  | Buffer.begin(), Buffer.data() + BeginLocInfo.second, | 
|  | Buffer.end()); | 
|  | Lex.SetCommentRetentionState(true); | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned NextIdx = 0; | 
|  | // Lex tokens in raw mode until we hit the end of the range, to avoid | 
|  | // entering #includes or expanding macros. | 
|  | while (true) { | 
|  | Token Tok; | 
|  | if (lexNext(Lex, Tok, NextIdx, NumTokens)) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | unsigned TokIdx = NextIdx-1; | 
|  | assert(Tok.getLocation() == | 
|  | SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(Tokens[TokIdx].int_data[1])); | 
|  |  | 
|  | reprocess: | 
|  | if (Tok.is(tok::hash) && Tok.isAtStartOfLine()) { | 
|  | // We have found a preprocessing directive. Annotate the tokens | 
|  | // appropriately. | 
|  | // | 
|  | // FIXME: Some simple tests here could identify macro definitions and | 
|  | // #undefs, to provide specific cursor kinds for those. | 
|  |  | 
|  | SourceLocation BeginLoc = Tok.getLocation(); | 
|  | if (lexNext(Lex, Tok, NextIdx, NumTokens)) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | MacroInfo *MI = nullptr; | 
|  | if (Tok.is(tok::raw_identifier) && Tok.getRawIdentifier() == "define") { | 
|  | if (lexNext(Lex, Tok, NextIdx, NumTokens)) | 
|  | break; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Tok.is(tok::raw_identifier)) { | 
|  | IdentifierInfo &II = | 
|  | PP.getIdentifierTable().get(Tok.getRawIdentifier()); | 
|  | SourceLocation MappedTokLoc = | 
|  | CXXUnit->mapLocationToPreamble(Tok.getLocation()); | 
|  | MI = getMacroInfo(II, MappedTokLoc, TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool finished = false; | 
|  | do { | 
|  | if (lexNext(Lex, Tok, NextIdx, NumTokens)) { | 
|  | finished = true; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | // If we are in a macro definition, check if the token was ever a | 
|  | // macro name and annotate it if that's the case. | 
|  | if (MI) { | 
|  | SourceLocation SaveLoc = Tok.getLocation(); | 
|  | Tok.setLocation(CXXUnit->mapLocationToPreamble(SaveLoc)); | 
|  | MacroDefinitionRecord *MacroDef = | 
|  | checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(MI, Tok, TU); | 
|  | Tok.setLocation(SaveLoc); | 
|  | if (MacroDef) | 
|  | Cursors[NextIdx - 1] = | 
|  | MakeMacroExpansionCursor(MacroDef, Tok.getLocation(), TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } while (!Tok.isAtStartOfLine()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned LastIdx = finished ? NextIdx-1 : NextIdx-2; | 
|  | assert(TokIdx <= LastIdx); | 
|  | SourceLocation EndLoc = | 
|  | SourceLocation::getFromRawEncoding(Tokens[LastIdx].int_data[1]); | 
|  | CXCursor Cursor = | 
|  | MakePreprocessingDirectiveCursor(SourceRange(BeginLoc, EndLoc), TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (; TokIdx <= LastIdx; ++TokIdx) | 
|  | updateCursorAnnotation(Cursors[TokIdx], Cursor); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (finished) | 
|  | break; | 
|  | goto reprocess; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // This gets run a separate thread to avoid stack blowout. | 
|  | static void clang_annotateTokensImpl(CXTranslationUnit TU, ASTUnit *CXXUnit, | 
|  | CXToken *Tokens, unsigned NumTokens, | 
|  | CXCursor *Cursors) { | 
|  | CIndexer *CXXIdx = TU->CIdx; | 
|  | if (CXXIdx->isOptEnabled(CXGlobalOpt_ThreadBackgroundPriorityForEditing)) | 
|  | setThreadBackgroundPriority(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Determine the region of interest, which contains all of the tokens. | 
|  | SourceRange RegionOfInterest; | 
|  | RegionOfInterest.setBegin( | 
|  | cxloc::translateSourceLocation(clang_getTokenLocation(TU, Tokens[0]))); | 
|  | RegionOfInterest.setEnd( | 
|  | cxloc::translateSourceLocation(clang_getTokenLocation(TU, | 
|  | Tokens[NumTokens-1]))); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Relex the tokens within the source range to look for preprocessing | 
|  | // directives. | 
|  | annotatePreprocessorTokens(TU, RegionOfInterest, Cursors, Tokens, NumTokens); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If begin location points inside a macro argument, set it to the expansion | 
|  | // location so we can have the full context when annotating semantically. | 
|  | { | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = CXXUnit->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | SourceLocation Loc = | 
|  | SM.getMacroArgExpandedLocation(RegionOfInterest.getBegin()); | 
|  | if (Loc.isMacroID()) | 
|  | RegionOfInterest.setBegin(SM.getExpansionLoc(Loc)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (CXXUnit->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord()) { | 
|  | // Search and mark tokens that are macro argument expansions. | 
|  | MarkMacroArgTokensVisitor Visitor(CXXUnit->getSourceManager(), | 
|  | Tokens, NumTokens); | 
|  | CursorVisitor MacroArgMarker(TU, | 
|  | MarkMacroArgTokensVisitorDelegate, &Visitor, | 
|  | /*VisitPreprocessorLast=*/true, | 
|  | /*VisitIncludedEntities=*/false, | 
|  | RegionOfInterest); | 
|  | MacroArgMarker.visitPreprocessedEntitiesInRegion(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Annotate all of the source locations in the region of interest that map to | 
|  | // a specific cursor. | 
|  | AnnotateTokensWorker W(Tokens, Cursors, NumTokens, TU, RegionOfInterest); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: We use a ridiculous stack size here because the data-recursion | 
|  | // algorithm uses a large stack frame than the non-data recursive version, | 
|  | // and AnnotationTokensWorker currently transforms the data-recursion | 
|  | // algorithm back into a traditional recursion by explicitly calling | 
|  | // VisitChildren().  We will need to remove this explicit recursive call. | 
|  | W.AnnotateTokens(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // If we ran into any entities that involve context-sensitive keywords, | 
|  | // take another pass through the tokens to mark them as such. | 
|  | if (W.hasContextSensitiveKeywords()) { | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTokens; ++I) { | 
|  | if (clang_getTokenKind(Tokens[I]) != CXToken_Identifier) | 
|  | continue; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl) { | 
|  | IdentifierInfo *II = static_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(Tokens[I].ptr_data); | 
|  | if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *Property | 
|  | = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCPropertyDecl>(getCursorDecl(Cursors[I]))) { | 
|  | if (Property->getPropertyAttributesAsWritten() != 0 && | 
|  | llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(II->getName()) | 
|  | .Case("readonly", true) | 
|  | .Case("assign", true) | 
|  | .Case("unsafe_unretained", true) | 
|  | .Case("readwrite", true) | 
|  | .Case("retain", true) | 
|  | .Case("copy", true) | 
|  | .Case("nonatomic", true) | 
|  | .Case("atomic", true) | 
|  | .Case("getter", true) | 
|  | .Case("setter", true) | 
|  | .Case("strong", true) | 
|  | .Case("weak", true) | 
|  | .Case("class", true) | 
|  | .Default(false)) | 
|  | Tokens[I].int_data[0] = CXToken_Keyword; | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_ObjCInstanceMethodDecl || | 
|  | Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_ObjCClassMethodDecl) { | 
|  | IdentifierInfo *II = static_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(Tokens[I].ptr_data); | 
|  | if (llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(II->getName()) | 
|  | .Case("in", true) | 
|  | .Case("out", true) | 
|  | .Case("inout", true) | 
|  | .Case("oneway", true) | 
|  | .Case("bycopy", true) | 
|  | .Case("byref", true) | 
|  | .Default(false)) | 
|  | Tokens[I].int_data[0] = CXToken_Keyword; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_CXXFinalAttr || | 
|  | Cursors[I].kind == CXCursor_CXXOverrideAttr) { | 
|  | Tokens[I].int_data[0] = CXToken_Keyword; | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_annotateTokens(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | CXToken *Tokens, unsigned NumTokens, | 
|  | CXCursor *Cursors) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (NumTokens == 0 || !Tokens || !Cursors) { | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { *Log << "<null input>"; } | 
|  | return; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | LOG_FUNC_SECTION { | 
|  | *Log << TU << ' '; | 
|  | CXSourceLocation bloc = clang_getTokenLocation(TU, Tokens[0]); | 
|  | CXSourceLocation eloc = clang_getTokenLocation(TU, Tokens[NumTokens-1]); | 
|  | *Log << clang_getRange(bloc, eloc); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Any token we don't specifically annotate will have a NULL cursor. | 
|  | CXCursor C = clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTokens; ++I) | 
|  | Cursors[I] = C; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *CXXUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | if (!CXXUnit) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit::ConcurrencyCheck Check(*CXXUnit); | 
|  |  | 
|  | auto AnnotateTokensImpl = [=]() { | 
|  | clang_annotateTokensImpl(TU, CXXUnit, Tokens, NumTokens, Cursors); | 
|  | }; | 
|  | llvm::CrashRecoveryContext CRC; | 
|  | if (!RunSafely(CRC, AnnotateTokensImpl, GetSafetyThreadStackSize() * 2)) { | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "libclang: crash detected while annotating tokens\n"); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Operations for querying linkage of a cursor. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXLinkageKind clang_getCursorLinkage(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) | 
|  | return CXLinkage_Invalid; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor); | 
|  | if (const NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast_or_null<NamedDecl>(D)) | 
|  | switch (ND->getLinkageInternal()) { | 
|  | case NoLinkage: | 
|  | case VisibleNoLinkage: return CXLinkage_NoLinkage; | 
|  | case ModuleInternalLinkage: | 
|  | case InternalLinkage: return CXLinkage_Internal; | 
|  | case UniqueExternalLinkage: return CXLinkage_UniqueExternal; | 
|  | case ModuleLinkage: | 
|  | case ExternalLinkage: return CXLinkage_External; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXLinkage_Invalid; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Operations for querying visibility of a cursor. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXVisibilityKind clang_getCursorVisibility(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) | 
|  | return CXVisibility_Invalid; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor); | 
|  | if (const NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast_or_null<NamedDecl>(D)) | 
|  | switch (ND->getVisibility()) { | 
|  | case HiddenVisibility: return CXVisibility_Hidden; | 
|  | case ProtectedVisibility: return CXVisibility_Protected; | 
|  | case DefaultVisibility: return CXVisibility_Default; | 
|  | }; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXVisibility_Invalid; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Operations for querying language of a cursor. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CXLanguageKind getDeclLanguage(const Decl *D) { | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return CXLanguage_C; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (D->getKind()) { | 
|  | default: | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case Decl::ImplicitParam: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCCategory: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCCompatibleAlias: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCImplementation: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCInterface: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCIvar: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCMethod: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCProperty: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCPropertyImpl: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCProtocol: | 
|  | case Decl::ObjCTypeParam: | 
|  | return CXLanguage_ObjC; | 
|  | case Decl::CXXConstructor: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXConversion: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXDestructor: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXMethod: | 
|  | case Decl::CXXRecord: | 
|  | case Decl::ClassTemplate: | 
|  | case Decl::ClassTemplatePartialSpecialization: | 
|  | case Decl::ClassTemplateSpecialization: | 
|  | case Decl::Friend: | 
|  | case Decl::FriendTemplate: | 
|  | case Decl::FunctionTemplate: | 
|  | case Decl::LinkageSpec: | 
|  | case Decl::Namespace: | 
|  | case Decl::NamespaceAlias: | 
|  | case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: | 
|  | case Decl::StaticAssert: | 
|  | case Decl::TemplateTemplateParm: | 
|  | case Decl::TemplateTypeParm: | 
|  | case Decl::UnresolvedUsingTypename: | 
|  | case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue: | 
|  | case Decl::Using: | 
|  | case Decl::UsingDirective: | 
|  | case Decl::UsingShadow: | 
|  | return CXLanguage_CPlusPlus; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXLanguage_C; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CXAvailabilityKind getCursorAvailabilityForDecl(const Decl *D) { | 
|  | if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isDeleted()) | 
|  | return CXAvailability_NotAvailable; | 
|  |  | 
|  | switch (D->getAvailability()) { | 
|  | case AR_Available: | 
|  | case AR_NotYetIntroduced: | 
|  | if (const EnumConstantDecl *EnumConst = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return getCursorAvailabilityForDecl( | 
|  | cast<Decl>(EnumConst->getDeclContext())); | 
|  | return CXAvailability_Available; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case AR_Deprecated: | 
|  | return CXAvailability_Deprecated; | 
|  |  | 
|  | case AR_Unavailable: | 
|  | return CXAvailability_NotAvailable; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Unknown availability kind!"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum CXAvailabilityKind clang_getCursorAvailability(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor)) | 
|  | return getCursorAvailabilityForDecl(D); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXAvailability_Available; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static CXVersion convertVersion(VersionTuple In) { | 
|  | CXVersion Out = { -1, -1, -1 }; | 
|  | if (In.empty()) | 
|  | return Out; | 
|  |  | 
|  | Out.Major = In.getMajor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | Optional<unsigned> Minor = In.getMinor(); | 
|  | if (Minor.hasValue()) | 
|  | Out.Minor = *Minor; | 
|  | else | 
|  | return Out; | 
|  |  | 
|  | Optional<unsigned> Subminor = In.getSubminor(); | 
|  | if (Subminor.hasValue()) | 
|  | Out.Subminor = *Subminor; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Out; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static void getCursorPlatformAvailabilityForDecl( | 
|  | const Decl *D, int *always_deprecated, CXString *deprecated_message, | 
|  | int *always_unavailable, CXString *unavailable_message, | 
|  | SmallVectorImpl<AvailabilityAttr *> &AvailabilityAttrs) { | 
|  | bool HadAvailAttr = false; | 
|  | for (auto A : D->attrs()) { | 
|  | if (DeprecatedAttr *Deprecated = dyn_cast<DeprecatedAttr>(A)) { | 
|  | HadAvailAttr = true; | 
|  | if (always_deprecated) | 
|  | *always_deprecated = 1; | 
|  | if (deprecated_message) { | 
|  | clang_disposeString(*deprecated_message); | 
|  | *deprecated_message = cxstring::createDup(Deprecated->getMessage()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (UnavailableAttr *Unavailable = dyn_cast<UnavailableAttr>(A)) { | 
|  | HadAvailAttr = true; | 
|  | if (always_unavailable) | 
|  | *always_unavailable = 1; | 
|  | if (unavailable_message) { | 
|  | clang_disposeString(*unavailable_message); | 
|  | *unavailable_message = cxstring::createDup(Unavailable->getMessage()); | 
|  | } | 
|  | continue; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (AvailabilityAttr *Avail = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(A)) { | 
|  | AvailabilityAttrs.push_back(Avail); | 
|  | HadAvailAttr = true; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!HadAvailAttr) | 
|  | if (const EnumConstantDecl *EnumConst = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return getCursorPlatformAvailabilityForDecl( | 
|  | cast<Decl>(EnumConst->getDeclContext()), always_deprecated, | 
|  | deprecated_message, always_unavailable, unavailable_message, | 
|  | AvailabilityAttrs); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (AvailabilityAttrs.empty()) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm::sort(AvailabilityAttrs.begin(), AvailabilityAttrs.end(), | 
|  | [](AvailabilityAttr *LHS, AvailabilityAttr *RHS) { | 
|  | return LHS->getPlatform()->getName() < | 
|  | RHS->getPlatform()->getName(); | 
|  | }); | 
|  | ASTContext &Ctx = D->getASTContext(); | 
|  | auto It = std::unique( | 
|  | AvailabilityAttrs.begin(), AvailabilityAttrs.end(), | 
|  | [&Ctx](AvailabilityAttr *LHS, AvailabilityAttr *RHS) { | 
|  | if (LHS->getPlatform() != RHS->getPlatform()) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (LHS->getIntroduced() == RHS->getIntroduced() && | 
|  | LHS->getDeprecated() == RHS->getDeprecated() && | 
|  | LHS->getObsoleted() == RHS->getObsoleted() && | 
|  | LHS->getMessage() == RHS->getMessage() && | 
|  | LHS->getReplacement() == RHS->getReplacement()) | 
|  | return true; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if ((!LHS->getIntroduced().empty() && !RHS->getIntroduced().empty()) || | 
|  | (!LHS->getDeprecated().empty() && !RHS->getDeprecated().empty()) || | 
|  | (!LHS->getObsoleted().empty() && !RHS->getObsoleted().empty())) | 
|  | return false; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (LHS->getIntroduced().empty() && !RHS->getIntroduced().empty()) | 
|  | LHS->setIntroduced(Ctx, RHS->getIntroduced()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (LHS->getDeprecated().empty() && !RHS->getDeprecated().empty()) { | 
|  | LHS->setDeprecated(Ctx, RHS->getDeprecated()); | 
|  | if (LHS->getMessage().empty()) | 
|  | LHS->setMessage(Ctx, RHS->getMessage()); | 
|  | if (LHS->getReplacement().empty()) | 
|  | LHS->setReplacement(Ctx, RHS->getReplacement()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (LHS->getObsoleted().empty() && !RHS->getObsoleted().empty()) { | 
|  | LHS->setObsoleted(Ctx, RHS->getObsoleted()); | 
|  | if (LHS->getMessage().empty()) | 
|  | LHS->setMessage(Ctx, RHS->getMessage()); | 
|  | if (LHS->getReplacement().empty()) | 
|  | LHS->setReplacement(Ctx, RHS->getReplacement()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return true; | 
|  | }); | 
|  | AvailabilityAttrs.erase(It, AvailabilityAttrs.end()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_getCursorPlatformAvailability(CXCursor cursor, int *always_deprecated, | 
|  | CXString *deprecated_message, | 
|  | int *always_unavailable, | 
|  | CXString *unavailable_message, | 
|  | CXPlatformAvailability *availability, | 
|  | int availability_size) { | 
|  | if (always_deprecated) | 
|  | *always_deprecated = 0; | 
|  | if (deprecated_message) | 
|  | *deprecated_message = cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | if (always_unavailable) | 
|  | *always_unavailable = 0; | 
|  | if (unavailable_message) | 
|  | *unavailable_message = cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor); | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | SmallVector<AvailabilityAttr *, 8> AvailabilityAttrs; | 
|  | getCursorPlatformAvailabilityForDecl(D, always_deprecated, deprecated_message, | 
|  | always_unavailable, unavailable_message, | 
|  | AvailabilityAttrs); | 
|  | for (const auto &Avail : | 
|  | llvm::enumerate(llvm::makeArrayRef(AvailabilityAttrs) | 
|  | .take_front(availability_size))) { | 
|  | availability[Avail.index()].Platform = | 
|  | cxstring::createDup(Avail.value()->getPlatform()->getName()); | 
|  | availability[Avail.index()].Introduced = | 
|  | convertVersion(Avail.value()->getIntroduced()); | 
|  | availability[Avail.index()].Deprecated = | 
|  | convertVersion(Avail.value()->getDeprecated()); | 
|  | availability[Avail.index()].Obsoleted = | 
|  | convertVersion(Avail.value()->getObsoleted()); | 
|  | availability[Avail.index()].Unavailable = Avail.value()->getUnavailable(); | 
|  | availability[Avail.index()].Message = | 
|  | cxstring::createDup(Avail.value()->getMessage()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return AvailabilityAttrs.size(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_disposeCXPlatformAvailability(CXPlatformAvailability *availability) { | 
|  | clang_disposeString(availability->Platform); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(availability->Message); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXLanguageKind clang_getCursorLanguage(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) | 
|  | return getDeclLanguage(cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXLanguage_Invalid; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTLSKind clang_getCursorTLSKind(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(cursor); | 
|  | if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | switch (VD->getTLSKind()) { | 
|  | case VarDecl::TLS_None: | 
|  | return CXTLS_None; | 
|  | case VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic: | 
|  | return CXTLS_Dynamic; | 
|  | case VarDecl::TLS_Static: | 
|  | return CXTLS_Static; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return CXTLS_None; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// If the given cursor is the "templated" declaration | 
|  | /// describing a class or function template, return the class or | 
|  | /// function template. | 
|  | static const Decl *maybeGetTemplateCursor(const Decl *D) { | 
|  | if (!D) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) | 
|  | if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) | 
|  | return FunTmpl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) | 
|  | if (ClassTemplateDecl *ClassTmpl = RD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) | 
|  | return ClassTmpl; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return D; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  |  | 
|  | enum CX_StorageClass clang_Cursor_getStorageClass(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | StorageClass sc = SC_None; | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (D) { | 
|  | if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | sc = FD->getStorageClass(); | 
|  | } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { | 
|  | sc = VD->getStorageClass(); | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | return CX_SC_Invalid; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | return CX_SC_Invalid; | 
|  | } | 
|  | switch (sc) { | 
|  | case SC_None: | 
|  | return CX_SC_None; | 
|  | case SC_Extern: | 
|  | return CX_SC_Extern; | 
|  | case SC_Static: | 
|  | return CX_SC_Static; | 
|  | case SC_PrivateExtern: | 
|  | return CX_SC_PrivateExtern; | 
|  | case SC_Auto: | 
|  | return CX_SC_Auto; | 
|  | case SC_Register: | 
|  | return CX_SC_Register; | 
|  | } | 
|  | llvm_unreachable("Unhandled storage class!"); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getCursorSemanticParent(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor)) { | 
|  | const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext(); | 
|  | if (!DC) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(maybeGetTemplateCursor(cast<Decl>(DC)), | 
|  | getCursorTU(cursor)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (clang_isStatement(cursor.kind) || clang_isExpression(cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor)) | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(D, getCursorTU(cursor)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXCursor clang_getCursorLexicalParent(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | if (clang_isDeclaration(cursor.kind)) { | 
|  | if (const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(cursor)) { | 
|  | const DeclContext *DC = D->getLexicalDeclContext(); | 
|  | if (!DC) | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return MakeCXCursor(maybeGetTemplateCursor(cast<Decl>(DC)), | 
|  | getCursorTU(cursor)); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // FIXME: Note that we can't easily compute the lexical context of a | 
|  | // statement or expression, so we return nothing. | 
|  | return clang_getNullCursor(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXFile clang_getIncludedFile(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | if (cursor.kind != CXCursor_InclusionDirective) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const InclusionDirective *ID = getCursorInclusionDirective(cursor); | 
|  | return const_cast<FileEntry *>(ID->getFile()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_getObjCPropertyAttributes(CXCursor C, unsigned reserved) { | 
|  | if (C.kind != CXCursor_ObjCPropertyDecl) | 
|  | return CXObjCPropertyAttr_noattr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned Result = CXObjCPropertyAttr_noattr; | 
|  | const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(getCursorDecl(C)); | 
|  | ObjCPropertyDecl::PropertyAttributeKind Attr = | 
|  | PD->getPropertyAttributesAsWritten(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | #define SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(A) \ | 
|  | if (Attr & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_##A) \ | 
|  | Result |= CXObjCPropertyAttr_##A | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(readonly); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(getter); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(assign); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(readwrite); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(retain); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(copy); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(nonatomic); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(setter); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(atomic); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(weak); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(strong); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(unsafe_unretained); | 
|  | SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR(class); | 
|  | #undef SET_CXOBJCPROP_ATTR | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_getObjCDeclQualifiers(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return CXObjCDeclQualifier_None; | 
|  |  | 
|  | Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT = Decl::OBJC_TQ_None; | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) | 
|  | QT = MD->getObjCDeclQualifier(); | 
|  | else if (const ParmVarDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) | 
|  | QT = PD->getObjCDeclQualifier(); | 
|  | if (QT == Decl::OBJC_TQ_None) | 
|  | return CXObjCDeclQualifier_None; | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned Result = CXObjCDeclQualifier_None; | 
|  | if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_In; | 
|  | if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Inout; | 
|  | if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Out; | 
|  | if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Bycopy; | 
|  | if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Byref; | 
|  | if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway) Result |= CXObjCDeclQualifier_Oneway; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Result; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_isObjCOptional(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return PD->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyDecl::Optional; | 
|  | if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return MD->getImplementationControl() == ObjCMethodDecl::Optional; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_isVariadic(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return FD->isVariadic(); | 
|  | if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return MD->isVariadic(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Cursor_isExternalSymbol(CXCursor C, | 
|  | CXString *language, CXString *definedIn, | 
|  | unsigned *isGenerated) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (auto *attr = D->getExternalSourceSymbolAttr()) { | 
|  | if (language) | 
|  | *language = cxstring::createDup(attr->getLanguage()); | 
|  | if (definedIn) | 
|  | *definedIn = cxstring::createDup(attr->getDefinedIn()); | 
|  | if (isGenerated) | 
|  | *isGenerated = attr->getGeneratedDeclaration(); | 
|  | return 1; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceRange clang_Cursor_getCommentRange(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | ASTContext &Context = getCursorContext(C); | 
|  | const RawComment *RC = Context.getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D); | 
|  | if (!RC) | 
|  | return clang_getNullRange(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxloc::translateSourceRange(Context, RC->getSourceRange()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_Cursor_getRawCommentText(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return cxstring::createNull(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | ASTContext &Context = getCursorContext(C); | 
|  | const RawComment *RC = Context.getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D); | 
|  | StringRef RawText = RC ? RC->getRawText(Context.getSourceManager()) : | 
|  | StringRef(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Don't duplicate the string because RawText points directly into source | 
|  | // code. | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(RawText); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_Cursor_getBriefCommentText(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return cxstring::createNull(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const ASTContext &Context = getCursorContext(C); | 
|  | const RawComment *RC = Context.getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (RC) { | 
|  | StringRef BriefText = RC->getBriefText(Context); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Don't duplicate the string because RawComment ensures that this memory | 
|  | // will not go away. | 
|  | return cxstring::createRef(BriefText); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxstring::createNull(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXModule clang_Cursor_getModule(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (C.kind == CXCursor_ModuleImportDecl) { | 
|  | if (const ImportDecl *ImportD = | 
|  | dyn_cast_or_null<ImportDecl>(getCursorDecl(C))) | 
|  | return ImportD->getImportedModule(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXModule clang_getModuleForFile(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXFile File) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (!File) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | FileEntry *FE = static_cast<FileEntry *>(File); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit &Unit = *cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | HeaderSearch &HS = Unit.getPreprocessor().getHeaderSearchInfo(); | 
|  | ModuleMap::KnownHeader Header = HS.findModuleForHeader(FE); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return Header.getModule(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXFile clang_Module_getASTFile(CXModule CXMod) { | 
|  | if (!CXMod) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod); | 
|  | return const_cast<FileEntry *>(Mod->getASTFile()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXModule clang_Module_getParent(CXModule CXMod) { | 
|  | if (!CXMod) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod); | 
|  | return Mod->Parent; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_Module_getName(CXModule CXMod) { | 
|  | if (!CXMod) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Mod->Name); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_Module_getFullName(CXModule CXMod) { | 
|  | if (!CXMod) | 
|  | return cxstring::createEmpty(); | 
|  | Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod); | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(Mod->getFullModuleName()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | int clang_Module_isSystem(CXModule CXMod) { | 
|  | if (!CXMod) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod); | 
|  | return Mod->IsSystem; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_Module_getNumTopLevelHeaders(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | CXModule CXMod) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (!CXMod) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod); | 
|  | FileManager &FileMgr = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->getFileManager(); | 
|  | ArrayRef<const FileEntry *> TopHeaders = Mod->getTopHeaders(FileMgr); | 
|  | return TopHeaders.size(); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXFile clang_Module_getTopLevelHeader(CXTranslationUnit TU, | 
|  | CXModule CXMod, unsigned Index) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  | if (!CXMod) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | Module *Mod = static_cast<Module*>(CXMod); | 
|  | FileManager &FileMgr = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)->getFileManager(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | ArrayRef<const FileEntry *> TopHeaders = Mod->getTopHeaders(FileMgr); | 
|  | if (Index < TopHeaders.size()) | 
|  | return const_cast<FileEntry *>(TopHeaders[Index]); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // C++ AST instrospection. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXConstructor_isDefaultConstructor(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | return (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXConstructor_isCopyConstructor(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | return (Constructor && Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXConstructor_isMoveConstructor(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | return (Constructor && Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXConstructor_isConvertingConstructor(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | // Passing 'false' excludes constructors marked 'explicit'. | 
|  | return (Constructor && Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(false)) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXField_isMutable(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (const auto D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C)) | 
|  | if (const auto FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) | 
|  | return FD->isMutable() ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isPureVirtual(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXMethodDecl *Method = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | return (Method && Method->isVirtual() && Method->isPure()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isConst(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXMethodDecl *Method = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | return (Method && (Method->getTypeQualifiers() & Qualifiers::Const)) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isDefaulted(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXMethodDecl *Method = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | return (Method && Method->isDefaulted()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isStatic(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXMethodDecl *Method = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | return (Method && Method->isStatic()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXMethod_isVirtual(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const CXXMethodDecl *Method = | 
|  | D ? dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D->getAsFunction()) : nullptr; | 
|  | return (Method && Method->isVirtual()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_CXXRecord_isAbstract(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const auto *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | const auto *RD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(D); | 
|  | if (RD) | 
|  | RD = RD->getDefinition(); | 
|  | return (RD && RD->isAbstract()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned clang_EnumDecl_isScoped(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (!clang_isDeclaration(C.kind)) | 
|  | return 0; | 
|  |  | 
|  | const Decl *D = cxcursor::getCursorDecl(C); | 
|  | auto *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(D); | 
|  | return (Enum && Enum->isScoped()) ? 1 : 0; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Attribute introspection. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXType clang_getIBOutletCollectionType(CXCursor C) { | 
|  | if (C.kind != CXCursor_IBOutletCollectionAttr) | 
|  | return cxtype::MakeCXType(QualType(), cxcursor::getCursorTU(C)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const IBOutletCollectionAttr *A = | 
|  | cast<IBOutletCollectionAttr>(cxcursor::getCursorAttr(C)); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return cxtype::MakeCXType(A->getInterface(), cxcursor::getCursorTU(C)); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Inspecting memory usage. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | typedef std::vector<CXTUResourceUsageEntry> MemUsageEntries; | 
|  |  | 
|  | static inline void createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(MemUsageEntries &entries, | 
|  | enum CXTUResourceUsageKind k, | 
|  | unsigned long amount) { | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsageEntry entry = { k, amount }; | 
|  | entries.push_back(entry); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const char *clang_getTUResourceUsageName(CXTUResourceUsageKind kind) { | 
|  | const char *str = ""; | 
|  | switch (kind) { | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_AST: | 
|  | str = "ASTContext: expressions, declarations, and types"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_Identifiers: | 
|  | str = "ASTContext: identifiers"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_Selectors: | 
|  | str = "ASTContext: selectors"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_GlobalCompletionResults: | 
|  | str = "Code completion: cached global results"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManagerContentCache: | 
|  | str = "SourceManager: content cache allocator"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_AST_SideTables: | 
|  | str = "ASTContext: side tables"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_Malloc: | 
|  | str = "SourceManager: malloc'ed memory buffers"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_MMap: | 
|  | str = "SourceManager: mmap'ed memory buffers"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_Malloc: | 
|  | str = "ExternalASTSource: malloc'ed memory buffers"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_MMap: | 
|  | str = "ExternalASTSource: mmap'ed memory buffers"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor: | 
|  | str = "Preprocessor: malloc'ed memory"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_PreprocessingRecord: | 
|  | str = "Preprocessor: PreprocessingRecord"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_DataStructures: | 
|  | str = "SourceManager: data structures and tables"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | case CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor_HeaderSearch: | 
|  | str = "Preprocessor: header search tables"; | 
|  | break; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return str; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage clang_getCXTUResourceUsage(CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage usage = { (void*) nullptr, 0, nullptr }; | 
|  | return usage; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *astUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | std::unique_ptr<MemUsageEntries> entries(new MemUsageEntries()); | 
|  | ASTContext &astContext = astUnit->getASTContext(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is used by AST nodes and types? | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, CXTUResourceUsage_AST, | 
|  | (unsigned long) astContext.getASTAllocatedMemory()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is used by identifiers? | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, CXTUResourceUsage_Identifiers, | 
|  | (unsigned long) astContext.Idents.getAllocator().getTotalMemory()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is used for selectors? | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, CXTUResourceUsage_Selectors, | 
|  | (unsigned long) astContext.Selectors.getTotalMemory()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is used by ASTContext's side tables? | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, CXTUResourceUsage_AST_SideTables, | 
|  | (unsigned long) astContext.getSideTableAllocatedMemory()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is used for caching global code completion results? | 
|  | unsigned long completionBytes = 0; | 
|  | if (GlobalCodeCompletionAllocator *completionAllocator = | 
|  | astUnit->getCachedCompletionAllocator().get()) { | 
|  | completionBytes = completionAllocator->getTotalMemory(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_GlobalCompletionResults, | 
|  | completionBytes); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is being used by SourceManager's content cache? | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManagerContentCache, | 
|  | (unsigned long) astContext.getSourceManager().getContentCacheSize()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is being used by the MemoryBuffer's in SourceManager? | 
|  | const SourceManager::MemoryBufferSizes &srcBufs = | 
|  | astUnit->getSourceManager().getMemoryBufferSizes(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_Malloc, | 
|  | (unsigned long) srcBufs.malloc_bytes); | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_Membuffer_MMap, | 
|  | (unsigned long) srcBufs.mmap_bytes); | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_SourceManager_DataStructures, | 
|  | (unsigned long) astContext.getSourceManager() | 
|  | .getDataStructureSizes()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is being used by the ExternalASTSource? | 
|  | if (ExternalASTSource *esrc = astContext.getExternalSource()) { | 
|  | const ExternalASTSource::MemoryBufferSizes &sizes = | 
|  | esrc->getMemoryBufferSizes(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_Malloc, | 
|  | (unsigned long) sizes.malloc_bytes); | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_ExternalASTSource_Membuffer_MMap, | 
|  | (unsigned long) sizes.mmap_bytes); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | // How much memory is being used by the Preprocessor? | 
|  | Preprocessor &pp = astUnit->getPreprocessor(); | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor, | 
|  | pp.getTotalMemory()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (PreprocessingRecord *pRec = pp.getPreprocessingRecord()) { | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_PreprocessingRecord, | 
|  | pRec->getTotalMemory()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | createCXTUResourceUsageEntry(*entries, | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage_Preprocessor_HeaderSearch, | 
|  | pp.getHeaderSearchInfo().getTotalMemory()); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage usage = { (void*) entries.get(), | 
|  | (unsigned) entries->size(), | 
|  | !entries->empty() ? &(*entries)[0] : nullptr }; | 
|  | (void)entries.release(); | 
|  | return usage; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_disposeCXTUResourceUsage(CXTUResourceUsage usage) { | 
|  | if (usage.data) | 
|  | delete (MemUsageEntries*) usage.data; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceRangeList *clang_getSkippedRanges(CXTranslationUnit TU, CXFile file) { | 
|  | CXSourceRangeList *skipped = new CXSourceRangeList; | 
|  | skipped->count = 0; | 
|  | skipped->ranges = nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return skipped; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (!file) | 
|  | return skipped; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *astUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | PreprocessingRecord *ppRec = astUnit->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord(); | 
|  | if (!ppRec) | 
|  | return skipped; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTContext &Ctx = astUnit->getASTContext(); | 
|  | SourceManager &sm = Ctx.getSourceManager(); | 
|  | FileEntry *fileEntry = static_cast<FileEntry *>(file); | 
|  | FileID wantedFileID = sm.translateFile(fileEntry); | 
|  | bool isMainFile = wantedFileID == sm.getMainFileID(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const std::vector<SourceRange> &SkippedRanges = ppRec->getSkippedRanges(); | 
|  | std::vector<SourceRange> wantedRanges; | 
|  | for (std::vector<SourceRange>::const_iterator i = SkippedRanges.begin(), ei = SkippedRanges.end(); | 
|  | i != ei; ++i) { | 
|  | if (sm.getFileID(i->getBegin()) == wantedFileID || sm.getFileID(i->getEnd()) == wantedFileID) | 
|  | wantedRanges.push_back(*i); | 
|  | else if (isMainFile && (astUnit->isInPreambleFileID(i->getBegin()) || astUnit->isInPreambleFileID(i->getEnd()))) | 
|  | wantedRanges.push_back(*i); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | skipped->count = wantedRanges.size(); | 
|  | skipped->ranges = new CXSourceRange[skipped->count]; | 
|  | for (unsigned i = 0, ei = skipped->count; i != ei; ++i) | 
|  | skipped->ranges[i] = cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, wantedRanges[i]); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return skipped; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXSourceRangeList *clang_getAllSkippedRanges(CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | CXSourceRangeList *skipped = new CXSourceRangeList; | 
|  | skipped->count = 0; | 
|  | skipped->ranges = nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (isNotUsableTU(TU)) { | 
|  | LOG_BAD_TU(TU); | 
|  | return skipped; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *astUnit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | PreprocessingRecord *ppRec = astUnit->getPreprocessor().getPreprocessingRecord(); | 
|  | if (!ppRec) | 
|  | return skipped; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTContext &Ctx = astUnit->getASTContext(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | const std::vector<SourceRange> &SkippedRanges = ppRec->getSkippedRanges(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | skipped->count = SkippedRanges.size(); | 
|  | skipped->ranges = new CXSourceRange[skipped->count]; | 
|  | for (unsigned i = 0, ei = skipped->count; i != ei; ++i) | 
|  | skipped->ranges[i] = cxloc::translateSourceRange(Ctx, SkippedRanges[i]); | 
|  |  | 
|  | return skipped; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang_disposeSourceRangeList(CXSourceRangeList *ranges) { | 
|  | if (ranges) { | 
|  | delete[] ranges->ranges; | 
|  | delete ranges; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang::PrintLibclangResourceUsage(CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | CXTUResourceUsage Usage = clang_getCXTUResourceUsage(TU); | 
|  | for (unsigned I = 0; I != Usage.numEntries; ++I) | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "  %s: %lu\n", | 
|  | clang_getTUResourceUsageName(Usage.entries[I].kind), | 
|  | Usage.entries[I].amount); | 
|  |  | 
|  | clang_disposeCXTUResourceUsage(Usage); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  | // Misc. utility functions. | 
|  | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | 
|  |  | 
|  | /// Default to using our desired 8 MB stack size on "safety" threads. | 
|  | static unsigned SafetyStackThreadSize = DesiredStackSize; | 
|  |  | 
|  | namespace clang { | 
|  |  | 
|  | bool RunSafely(llvm::CrashRecoveryContext &CRC, llvm::function_ref<void()> Fn, | 
|  | unsigned Size) { | 
|  | if (!Size) | 
|  | Size = GetSafetyThreadStackSize(); | 
|  | if (Size && !getenv("LIBCLANG_NOTHREADS")) | 
|  | return CRC.RunSafelyOnThread(Fn, Size); | 
|  | return CRC.RunSafely(Fn); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | unsigned GetSafetyThreadStackSize() { | 
|  | return SafetyStackThreadSize; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void SetSafetyThreadStackSize(unsigned Value) { | 
|  | SafetyStackThreadSize = Value; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void clang::setThreadBackgroundPriority() { | 
|  | if (getenv("LIBCLANG_BGPRIO_DISABLE")) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef USE_DARWIN_THREADS | 
|  | setpriority(PRIO_DARWIN_THREAD, 0, PRIO_DARWIN_BG); | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | void cxindex::printDiagsToStderr(ASTUnit *Unit) { | 
|  | if (!Unit) | 
|  | return; | 
|  |  | 
|  | for (ASTUnit::stored_diag_iterator D = Unit->stored_diag_begin(), | 
|  | DEnd = Unit->stored_diag_end(); | 
|  | D != DEnd; ++D) { | 
|  | CXStoredDiagnostic Diag(*D, Unit->getLangOpts()); | 
|  | CXString Msg = clang_formatDiagnostic(&Diag, | 
|  | clang_defaultDiagnosticDisplayOptions()); | 
|  | fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", clang_getCString(Msg)); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(Msg); | 
|  | } | 
|  | #ifdef _WIN32 | 
|  | // On Windows, force a flush, since there may be multiple copies of | 
|  | // stderr and stdout in the file system, all with different buffers | 
|  | // but writing to the same device. | 
|  | fflush(stderr); | 
|  | #endif | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | MacroInfo *cxindex::getMacroInfo(const IdentifierInfo &II, | 
|  | SourceLocation MacroDefLoc, | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU){ | 
|  | if (MacroDefLoc.isInvalid() || !TU) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | if (!II.hadMacroDefinition()) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | Preprocessor &PP = Unit->getPreprocessor(); | 
|  | MacroDirective *MD = PP.getLocalMacroDirectiveHistory(&II); | 
|  | if (MD) { | 
|  | for (MacroDirective::DefInfo | 
|  | Def = MD->getDefinition(); Def; Def = Def.getPreviousDefinition()) { | 
|  | if (MacroDefLoc == Def.getMacroInfo()->getDefinitionLoc()) | 
|  | return Def.getMacroInfo(); | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | const MacroInfo *cxindex::getMacroInfo(const MacroDefinitionRecord *MacroDef, | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | if (!MacroDef || !TU) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | const IdentifierInfo *II = MacroDef->getName(); | 
|  | if (!II) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return getMacroInfo(*II, MacroDef->getLocation(), TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | MacroDefinitionRecord * | 
|  | cxindex::checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(const MacroInfo *MI, const Token &Tok, | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | if (!MI || !TU) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | if (Tok.isNot(tok::raw_identifier)) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (MI->getNumTokens() == 0) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | SourceRange DefRange(MI->getReplacementToken(0).getLocation(), | 
|  | MI->getDefinitionEndLoc()); | 
|  | ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Check that the token is inside the definition and not its argument list. | 
|  | SourceManager &SM = Unit->getSourceManager(); | 
|  | if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(Tok.getLocation(), DefRange.getBegin())) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | if (SM.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(DefRange.getEnd(), Tok.getLocation())) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | Preprocessor &PP = Unit->getPreprocessor(); | 
|  | PreprocessingRecord *PPRec = PP.getPreprocessingRecord(); | 
|  | if (!PPRec) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | IdentifierInfo &II = PP.getIdentifierTable().get(Tok.getRawIdentifier()); | 
|  | if (!II.hadMacroDefinition()) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // Check that the identifier is not one of the macro arguments. | 
|  | if (std::find(MI->param_begin(), MI->param_end(), &II) != MI->param_end()) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | MacroDirective *InnerMD = PP.getLocalMacroDirectiveHistory(&II); | 
|  | if (!InnerMD) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return PPRec->findMacroDefinition(InnerMD->getMacroInfo()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | MacroDefinitionRecord * | 
|  | cxindex::checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(const MacroInfo *MI, SourceLocation Loc, | 
|  | CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | if (Loc.isInvalid() || !MI || !TU) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (MI->getNumTokens() == 0) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU); | 
|  | Preprocessor &PP = Unit->getPreprocessor(); | 
|  | if (!PP.getPreprocessingRecord()) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  | Loc = Unit->getSourceManager().getSpellingLoc(Loc); | 
|  | Token Tok; | 
|  | if (PP.getRawToken(Loc, Tok)) | 
|  | return nullptr; | 
|  |  | 
|  | return checkForMacroInMacroDefinition(MI, Tok, TU); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString clang_getClangVersion() { | 
|  | return cxstring::createDup(getClangFullVersion()); | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXTranslationUnit TU) { | 
|  | if (TU) { | 
|  | if (ASTUnit *Unit = cxtu::getASTUnit(TU)) { | 
|  | LogOS << '<' << Unit->getMainFileName() << '>'; | 
|  | if (Unit->isMainFileAST()) | 
|  | LogOS << " (" << Unit->getASTFileName() << ')'; | 
|  | return *this; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | LogOS << "<NULL TU>"; | 
|  | } | 
|  | return *this; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(const FileEntry *FE) { | 
|  | *this << FE->getName(); | 
|  | return *this; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXCursor cursor) { | 
|  | CXString cursorName = clang_getCursorDisplayName(cursor); | 
|  | *this << cursorName << "@" << clang_getCursorLocation(cursor); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(cursorName); | 
|  | return *this; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXSourceLocation Loc) { | 
|  | CXFile File; | 
|  | unsigned Line, Column; | 
|  | clang_getFileLocation(Loc, &File, &Line, &Column, nullptr); | 
|  | CXString FileName = clang_getFileName(File); | 
|  | *this << llvm::format("(%s:%d:%d)", clang_getCString(FileName), Line, Column); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(FileName); | 
|  | return *this; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXSourceRange range) { | 
|  | CXSourceLocation BLoc = clang_getRangeStart(range); | 
|  | CXSourceLocation ELoc = clang_getRangeEnd(range); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXFile BFile; | 
|  | unsigned BLine, BColumn; | 
|  | clang_getFileLocation(BLoc, &BFile, &BLine, &BColumn, nullptr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXFile EFile; | 
|  | unsigned ELine, EColumn; | 
|  | clang_getFileLocation(ELoc, &EFile, &ELine, &EColumn, nullptr); | 
|  |  | 
|  | CXString BFileName = clang_getFileName(BFile); | 
|  | if (BFile == EFile) { | 
|  | *this << llvm::format("[%s %d:%d-%d:%d]", clang_getCString(BFileName), | 
|  | BLine, BColumn, ELine, EColumn); | 
|  | } else { | 
|  | CXString EFileName = clang_getFileName(EFile); | 
|  | *this << llvm::format("[%s:%d:%d - ", clang_getCString(BFileName), | 
|  | BLine, BColumn) | 
|  | << llvm::format("%s:%d:%d]", clang_getCString(EFileName), | 
|  | ELine, EColumn); | 
|  | clang_disposeString(EFileName); | 
|  | } | 
|  | clang_disposeString(BFileName); | 
|  | return *this; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(CXString Str) { | 
|  | *this << clang_getCString(Str); | 
|  | return *this; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | Logger &cxindex::Logger::operator<<(const llvm::format_object_base &Fmt) { | 
|  | LogOS << Fmt; | 
|  | return *this; | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | static llvm::ManagedStatic<llvm::sys::Mutex> LoggingMutex; | 
|  |  | 
|  | cxindex::Logger::~Logger() { | 
|  | llvm::sys::ScopedLock L(*LoggingMutex); | 
|  |  | 
|  | static llvm::TimeRecord sBeginTR = llvm::TimeRecord::getCurrentTime(); | 
|  |  | 
|  | raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); | 
|  | OS << "[libclang:" << Name << ':'; | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef USE_DARWIN_THREADS | 
|  | // TODO: Portability. | 
|  | mach_port_t tid = pthread_mach_thread_np(pthread_self()); | 
|  | OS << tid << ':'; | 
|  | #endif | 
|  |  | 
|  | llvm::TimeRecord TR = llvm::TimeRecord::getCurrentTime(); | 
|  | OS << llvm::format("%7.4f] ", TR.getWallTime() - sBeginTR.getWallTime()); | 
|  | OS << Msg << '\n'; | 
|  |  | 
|  | if (Trace) { | 
|  | llvm::sys::PrintStackTrace(OS); | 
|  | OS << "--------------------------------------------------\n"; | 
|  | } | 
|  | } | 
|  |  | 
|  | #ifdef CLANG_TOOL_EXTRA_BUILD | 
|  | // This anchor is used to force the linker to link the clang-tidy plugin. | 
|  | extern volatile int ClangTidyPluginAnchorSource; | 
|  | static int LLVM_ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED ClangTidyPluginAnchorDestination = | 
|  | ClangTidyPluginAnchorSource; | 
|  |  | 
|  | // This anchor is used to force the linker to link the clang-include-fixer | 
|  | // plugin. | 
|  | extern volatile int ClangIncludeFixerPluginAnchorSource; | 
|  | static int LLVM_ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED ClangIncludeFixerPluginAnchorDestination = | 
|  | ClangIncludeFixerPluginAnchorSource; | 
|  | #endif |